blob: 309d076aa7b512963b1ca4ea81c7e05600eb1513 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet05f01882020-09-25 18:40:47 +02007 2020/09/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001054 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1055 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1056 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1057 designed to be used with a local log server.
1058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1063 logger consumes.
1064
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001065 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1066 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1067 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1068 used with a local log server.
1069
1070 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1071 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1072 designed to be used with a local log server.
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1075 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1076 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1077 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1078
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001079 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1080 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1081 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1082 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1083 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1084
1085 <sample_size>
1086 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1087 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1088 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1089 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1090 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1091
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001092 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001094 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1095 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1096 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1097
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001098 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1099 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1100 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1101 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
1103 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001104 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1105 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1106 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1107 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1108 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1109 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001111 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001113log-send-hostname [<string>]
1114 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1115 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1116 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1117 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1118 the logs.
1119
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001120log-tag <string>
1121 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1122 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1123 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001124 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126lua-load <file>
1127 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1128 used multiple times.
1129
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001130lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1131 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1132 variable.
1133 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1134 to "path".
1135
1136 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1137 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1138 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1139 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1140 will be checked earlier.
1141
1142 As an example by specifying the following path:
1143
1144 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1145 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1146
1147 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1148 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1149 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1150 paths if that does not exist either.
1151
1152 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1153 documentation.
1154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1157 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1158 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001159 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001160 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1161 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001162 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1163 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1164 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1165 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1166 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001167
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001168 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001170mworker-max-reloads <number>
1171 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001172 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1174 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1175 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177nbproc <number>
1178 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1179 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1180 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001181 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1182 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001183 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1184 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186nbthread <number>
1187 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001188 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1189 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1190 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1191 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1192 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001193 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1194 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1195 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1196 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1197 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1198 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1199 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001202 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1203 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1204 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1205 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001207pp2-never-send-local
1208 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1209 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1210 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1211 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1212 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1213 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1214 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1215 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1216 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1217 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1218 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220presetenv <name> <value>
1221 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1222 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1223 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1224 and "unsetenv".
1225
1226resetenv [<name> ...]
1227 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1228 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1229 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1230 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1231 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1232 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1233 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1234 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1235
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001236stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001237 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1238 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1239 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1240 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1241 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1242 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001243 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001244 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1245 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1246 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1247 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001248
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001249server-state-base <directory>
1250 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001251 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1252 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001253
1254server-state-file <file>
1255 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1256 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1257 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1258 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1259 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1260 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1261 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1262 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001263 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1264 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001265
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001266setenv <name> <value>
1267 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1268 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1269 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1270 and "unsetenv".
1271
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001272set-dumpable
1273 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001274 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1275 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1276 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1277 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1278 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1279 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1280 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1281 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1282 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1283 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1284 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1285 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1286 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1287 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1288 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1289 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1290 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1294 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1301 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1302 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1307 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1308 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1309 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001313 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001315ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1318 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1319 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1320 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1321
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001322ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1324 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1325 keyword to see available options.
1326
1327 Example:
1328 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001329 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001330
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001331ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1333 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001334 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001335 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001336 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1337 information and recommendations see e.g.
1338 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1339 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1340 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1341 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1342 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001343
1344ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1347 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1348 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1349 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001350 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1351 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1352 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1353 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001354
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001355ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1357 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1358 keyword to see available options.
1359
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001360ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1362 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1363 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001364 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001365 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001366 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1367 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1368 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1369 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001370 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1371 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1372 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1373
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001374ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001375 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001376 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1377 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001378
1379 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1380 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1381 optimize the startup time.
1382
1383 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1384 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1385 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1386
1387 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001388 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001389
1390 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1391 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
William Lallemand98d215e2020-09-16 17:42:37 +02001392 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa.
1393 The multi-certificates bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were
1394 the only way back then to serve an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one with the
1395 same SNI. Since HAProxy 2.3 it does not use the OpenSSL bundle but it
1396 loads every certificates separately to emulate this behavior. At least
1397 OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required. It is recommended to specify all the certificates
1398 in the configuration instead of using the bundle feature.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001399
1400 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1401
1402 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1403
1404 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1405 not provided in the PEM file.
1406
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001407 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1408 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1409
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001410 The default behavior is "all".
1411
1412 Example:
1413 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1414 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1415 ssl-load-extra-files none
1416
1417 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1418
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001419ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1420 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1421 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1422 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1423
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001424ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001425 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001426 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1427 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1428 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1429 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1430 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1431 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001432 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001433
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001434stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1435 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1436 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1437 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001438 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001439 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001440
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001441 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1442 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1443 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001444
1445stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1446 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1447 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001448 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001449
1450stats maxconn <connections>
1451 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1452 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1453
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001454uid <number>
1455 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1456 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1457 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1458 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1459
1460ulimit-n <number>
1461 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1462 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1463 option.
1464
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001465unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1466 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1467
1468 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1469 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1470 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1471 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1472 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1473 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1474 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1475 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1476 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1477 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1478
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001479unsetenv [<name> ...]
1480 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1481 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1482 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1483 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1484 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1485 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1486 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1487
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001488user <user name>
1489 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1490 See also "uid" and "group".
1491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001492node <name>
1493 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1494
1495 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1496 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1497 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1498 traffic.
1499
1500description <text>
1501 Add a text that describes the instance.
1502
1503 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1504 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1505 "<" and ">" characters.
1506
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100150751degrees-data-file <file path>
1508 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001509 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001510
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001511 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001512 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1513
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000151451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001515 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1516 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1517 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1518
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001519 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001520 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1521
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200152251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001523 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1524 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1525
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001526 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1527 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1528
152951degrees-cache-size <number>
1530 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1531 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1532 By default, this cache is disabled.
1533
1534 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001535 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1536
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001537wurfl-data-file <file path>
1538 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1539 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1540
1541 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1542 with USE_WURFL=1.
1543
1544wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1545 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1546 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1547 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1548
1549 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1550
1551 Valid WURFL properties are:
1552 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1553
1554 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1555 device.
1556
1557 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1558 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1559
1560 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1561 particular web request.
1562
1563 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1564 used Libwurfl API version.
1565
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001566 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1567 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1568
1569 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1570 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1571
1572 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1573
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001574 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1575 with USE_WURFL=1.
1576
1577wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1578 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1579 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1580
1581 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1582 with USE_WURFL=1.
1583
1584wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1585 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1586 thus before the chroot.
1587
1588 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1589 with USE_WURFL=1.
1590
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001591wurfl-cache-size <size>
1592 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1593 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001594 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001595 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001596
1597 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1598 with USE_WURFL=1.
1599
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001600strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001601 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1602 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1603 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1604 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1605 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016073.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608-----------------------
1609
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001610busy-polling
1611 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1612 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1613 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1614 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1615 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1616 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1617 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1618 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1619 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1620 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1621 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1622 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1623 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1624 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1625 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1626 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1627 "poll" pollers.
1628
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001629 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1630 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1631 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1632
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001633max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1634 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1635 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1636 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1637 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1638 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1639 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1640 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1641 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001643maxconn <number>
1644 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1645 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1646 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001647 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1648 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1649 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1650 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001651 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1652 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1653 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1654 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1655 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1656 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001657
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001658maxconnrate <number>
1659 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1660 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1661 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1662 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1663 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1664 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1665 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1666 fairness.
1667
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001668maxcomprate <number>
1669 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001670 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001671 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1672 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1673 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001674 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001675 default value.
1676
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001677maxcompcpuusage <number>
1678 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1679 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1680 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1681 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1682 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1683 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1684 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1685 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1686
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001687maxpipes <number>
1688 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1689 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1690 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1691 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1692 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1693 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1694
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001695maxsessrate <number>
1696 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1697 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1698 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1699 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1700 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1701 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1702 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1703 fairness.
1704
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001705maxsslconn <number>
1706 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1707 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1708 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1709 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1710 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1711 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1712 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001713 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1714 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1715 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1716 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1717 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1718 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1719 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001720
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001721maxsslrate <number>
1722 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1723 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1724 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1725 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1726 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1727 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1728 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1729 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1730 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1731 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1732
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001733maxzlibmem <number>
1734 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1735 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1736 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001737 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1738 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1739 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1740
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001741noepoll
1742 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1743 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001744 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001745
1746nokqueue
1747 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1748 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1749 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1750
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001751noevports
1752 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1753 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1754 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1755 also "nopoll".
1756
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001757nopoll
1758 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1759 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001761 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1762 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001764nosplice
1765 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001766 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001767 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001768 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001769 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1770 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1771 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1772 "option splice-response".
1773
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001774nogetaddrinfo
1775 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1776 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1777
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001778noreuseport
1779 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1780 command line argument "-dR".
1781
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001782profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1783 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1784 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1785 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1786 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001787 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001788 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1789 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1790 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1791 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1792
1793 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1794 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1795 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1796 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1797 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001798 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1799 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1800 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1801 CLI.
1802
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001803spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001804 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1805 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1806 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1807 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1808 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1809 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001810
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001811ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001812 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001813 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001814 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1815 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1816 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1817 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1818 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1820 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001821 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1822 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1823 openssl configuration file uses:
1824 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1825
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001826ssl-mode-async
1827 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001828 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001829 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1830 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1831 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001832 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001833 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001834
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001835tune.buffers.limit <number>
1836 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1837 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1838 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1839 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1840 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001842 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1843 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1844 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1845 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1846 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1847 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1848 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1849 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1850 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1851
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001852tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1853 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1854 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1855 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1856 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1857
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001858tune.bufsize <number>
1859 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1860 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1861 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1862 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1863 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1864 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1865 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001866 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1867 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1868 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001869 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001870 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1871 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1872 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001873
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001874tune.chksize <number>
1875 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1876 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1877 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1878 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1879 checks whenever possible.
1880
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001881tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1882 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1883 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1884 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1885 this value. The default value is 1.
1886
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001887tune.fail-alloc
1888 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1889 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1890 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1891 gracefully.
1892
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001893tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1894 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1895 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1896 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1897 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1898 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1899
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001900tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1901 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1902 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1903 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1904 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1905 change it.
1906
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001907tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1908 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001909 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1910 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001911 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1912 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1913 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1914 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1915 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1916
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001917tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1918 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1919 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1920 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1921 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1922 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1923 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1924 recommended not to change this value.
1925
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001926tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1927 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1928 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1929 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1930 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1931 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1932 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1933 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1934
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001935tune.http.cookielen <number>
1936 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1937 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1938 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1939 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1940 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1941 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1942 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1943 to change this value.
1944
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001945tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1947 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001948 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001950 configuration directives too.
1951 The default value is 1024.
1952
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001953tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1954 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1955 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1956 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1957 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1958 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1959 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001960 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1961 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1962 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001963
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001964tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1965 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1966 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1967 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1968 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1969 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1970 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1971 this option to "off". The default is on.
1972
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001973tune.idletimer <timeout>
1974 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1975 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1976 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1977 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1978 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1979 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001980 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001981 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001982 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1983
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001984tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1985 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1986 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1987 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1988 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1989 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1990 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1991 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1992 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1993 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1994
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001995tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1996 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001997 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001998 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1999 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002000 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002001 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2002 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2003
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002004tune.lua.maxmem
2005 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2006 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2007 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2008 memory.
2009
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002010tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2011 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002012 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2013 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002014 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002015
2016tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2017 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2018 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2019 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2020 check servers.
2021
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002022tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2023 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2024 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2025 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002026 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002027
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002028tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002029 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2030 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2031 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2032 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2033 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2034 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2035 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2036 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2037 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2038 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002039
2040tune.maxpollevents <number>
2041 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2042 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2043 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2044 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2045 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2046
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002047tune.maxrewrite <number>
2048 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2049 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2050 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2051 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2052 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2053 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2054 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2055 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2056 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2057 bufsize.
2058
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002059tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2060 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2061 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2062 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2063 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2064 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2065 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2066 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2067 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2068 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002069 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2070 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002071 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2072 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2073 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2074 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2075 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2076 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2077 setting this parameter to 0.
2078
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002079tune.pipesize <number>
2080 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2081 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2082 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2083 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2084 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2085 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2086
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002087tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2088 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2089 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2090 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2091 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2092 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2093 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002094 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002095
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002096tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2097 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2098 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2099 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2100 default is 20.
2101
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002102tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2103tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2104 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2105 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2106 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002107 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002108 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002109 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2110 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2111
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002112tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002113 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002114 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2115 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2116 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2117 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2118
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002119tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002120 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002121 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002122 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2123 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2124 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2125
2126tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2127 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2128 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2129 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2130 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2131 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2132 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2133 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2134 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2135 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002136
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002137tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2138tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2139 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2140 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2141 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002142 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002143 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002144 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2145 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2146 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2147 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2148 notifying haproxy again.
2149
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002150tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002151 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2152 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2153 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002154 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002155 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002156 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002157 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2158 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2159 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002160 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2161 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002162
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002163tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002164 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002165 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2166 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2167 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2168 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2169 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2170
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002171tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2172 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2173 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2174 performances. This is disabled by default.
2175
2176 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2177 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2178
2179 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2180
2181 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2182
2183 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2184
2185 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2186 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2187 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2188
2189 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2190 converted.
2191
2192 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2193 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2194 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2195 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2196 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2197 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2198 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002199 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2200 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002201
2202 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2203
2204 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2205 only need this line:
2206
2207 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2208
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002209tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2210 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002211 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002212 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2213 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2214 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2215 being used for too long.
2216
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002217tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2218 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2219 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2220 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2221 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2222 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2223 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2224 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2225 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2226 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2227 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002228 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002229 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002230
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002231tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2232 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2233 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2234 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2235 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002236 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002237 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2238 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002239 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2240 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002241
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002242tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2243 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2244 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2245 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2246 1000 entries.
2247
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002248tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2249 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2250 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2251 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2252
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002253tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002254tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002255tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2256tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2257tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002258 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2259 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2260 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2261 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2262 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2263 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2264 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2265 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002266
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002267 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2268 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2269 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2270 all available space is consumed.
2271 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2272 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2273 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002274
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002275tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2276 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002277 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002278 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002279 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002280 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2281
2282tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2283 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2284 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002285 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2286 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022883.3. Debugging
2289--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002291debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002292 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2293 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2294 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2295 system startup.
2296
2297quiet
2298 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2299 line argument "-q".
2300
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002301zero-warning
2302 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2303 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2304 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2305 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2306 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2307 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2308
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023103.4. Userlists
2311--------------
2312It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2313http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2314it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2315
2316userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002317 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002318 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2319
2320group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002321 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002322 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2323 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2324
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002325user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2326 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002327 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2328 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002329 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2330 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2331 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2332 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002333
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002334 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2335 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2336 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2337 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2338 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2339 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2340 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2341 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2342 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002343
2344 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002345 userlist L1
2346 group G1 users tiger,scott
2347 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002348
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002349 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2350 user scott insecure-password elgato
2351 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002352
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002353 userlist L2
2354 group G1
2355 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002356
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002357 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2358 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2359 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002360
2361 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002362
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002363
23643.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002365----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002366It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2367several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2368instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2369values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2370automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2371In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2372using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2373tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2374reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2375Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2376that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2377each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002378
2379peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002380 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002381 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2382
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002383bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2384 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2385 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2386
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002387disabled
2388 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2389 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2390 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2391
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002392default-bind [param*]
2393 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2394
2395default-server [param*]
2396 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2397
2398 Arguments:
2399 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2400 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2401 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2402 details.
2403
2404
2405 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2406
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002407enable
2408 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2409
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002410log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2411 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2412 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2413 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2414 more details.
2415
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002416peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002417 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2418 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002419 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2420 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2421 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2422 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2423 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002424
2425 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2426 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2427
2428 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002429 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2430 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2431 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002433 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2434 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002435
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002436 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2437 "server" keyword explanation below).
2438
2439server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002440 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002441 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2442 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2443 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2444 of this "peers" section).
2445 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2446
2447
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002448 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002449 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002450 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002451 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2452 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2453 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002454
2455 backend mybackend
2456 mode tcp
2457 balance roundrobin
2458 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2459 stick on src
2460
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002461 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2462 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002463
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002464 Example:
2465 peers mypeers
2466 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2467 default-server ssl verify none
2468 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2469 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002470
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002471
2472table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2473 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2474
2475 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2476 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002477 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002478 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2479 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2480 "stick-table" keyword).
2481
2482 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2483 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2484 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2485 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2486 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2487 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2488 of the stick-table name as follows:
2489
2490 peers mypeers
2491 peer A ...
2492 peer B ...
2493 table t1 ...
2494
2495 frontend fe1
2496 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2497
2498 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2499 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2500
2501 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2502 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2503 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2504 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2505 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2506 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2507 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2508
2509 peers mypeers
2510 peer A ...
2511 peer B ...
2512 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2513
2514 backend t1
2515 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2516
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002517 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002518 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2519 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2520
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025213.6. Mailers
2522------------
2523It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2524If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2525in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2526
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002527mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002528 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2529 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2530
2531mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2532 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2533
2534 Example:
2535 mailers mymailers
2536 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2537 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2538
2539 backend mybackend
2540 mode tcp
2541 balance roundrobin
2542
2543 email-alert mailers mymailers
2544 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2545 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2546
2547 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2548 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2549
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002550timeout mail <time>
2551 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2552 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2553 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2554 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2555
2556 Example:
2557 mailers mymailers
2558 timeout mail 20s
2559 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002560
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025613.7. Programs
2562-------------
2563In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2564master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2565managed the same way as the workers.
2566
2567During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2568sequence as a worker:
2569
2570 - the master is re-executed
2571 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2572 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2573 instance of the program
2574
2575During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2576
2577program <name>
2578 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2579 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2580 the management guide).
2581
2582command <command> [arguments*]
2583 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2584 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2585 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2586 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2587
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002588user <user name>
2589 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2590 See also "group".
2591
2592group <group name>
2593 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2594 See also "user".
2595
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002596option start-on-reload
2597no option start-on-reload
2598 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2599 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2600 program section.
2601
2602
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026033.8. HTTP-errors
2604----------------
2605
2606It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2607imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2608several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2609
2610http-errors <name>
2611 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2612 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2613
2614errorfile <code> <file>
2615 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2616
2617 Arguments :
2618 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002619 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2620 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002621
2622 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2623 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2624 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2625 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2626 before any chroot is performed.
2627
2628 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2629
2630 Example:
2631 http-errors website-1
2632 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2633 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2634 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2635
2636 http-errors website-2
2637 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2638 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2639 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2640
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026413.9. Rings
2642----------
2643
2644It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2645servers or traces.
2646
2647ring <ringname>
2648 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2649
2650description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002651 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002652 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2653
2654format <format>
2655 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2656
2657 Arguments:
2658 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2659 one of the following :
2660
2661 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2662 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2663 designed to be used with a local log server.
2664
2665 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2666 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2667 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2668 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2669 is the default.
2670
2671 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2672 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2673
2674 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2675 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2676
2677 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2678 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2679 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2680 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2681 logger consumes.
2682
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002683 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2684 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2685 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2686 with a local log server.
2687
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002688 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2689 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2690 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2691 used with a local log server.
2692
2693maxlen <length>
2694 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2695 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2696 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2697
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002698server <name> <address> [param*]
2699 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2700 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2701 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2702 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2703 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2704 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2705 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2706 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2707 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002708 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2709 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002710
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002711size <size>
2712 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2713 set to BUFSIZE.
2714
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002715timeout connect <timeout>
2716 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2717
2718 Arguments :
2719 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2721 as explained at the top of this document.
2722
2723timeout server <timeout>
2724 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2725
2726 Arguments :
2727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2729 as explained at the top of this document.
2730
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002731 Example:
2732 global
2733 log ring@myring local7
2734
2735 ring myring
2736 description "My local buffer"
2737 format rfc3164
2738 maxlen 1200
2739 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002740 timeout connect 5s
2741 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002742 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002743
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027443.10. Log forwarding
2745-------------------
2746
2747It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2748haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2749
2750log-forward <name>
2751 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2752
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002753dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
2754 Used to configure a UDP log listener to receive messages to forward. Only UDP
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002755 listeners are allowed. Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a
2756 port. This supports for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph
2757 among which "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
2758 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002759
2760log global
2761log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2762 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2763 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2764 documentation.
2765 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2766 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2767 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2768 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2769 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2770
2771 Example:
2772 global
2773 log stderr format iso local7
2774
2775 ring myring
2776 description "My local buffer"
2777 format rfc5424
2778 maxlen 1200
2779 size 32764
2780 timeout connect 5s
2781 timeout server 10s
2782 # syslog tcp server
2783 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2784
2785 log-forward sylog-loadb
2786 bind udp4@127.0.0.1:1514
2787 # all messages on stderr
2788 log global
2789 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2790 log ring@myring local0
2791 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2792 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2793 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2794 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2795 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027974. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002798----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002800Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002801 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002802 - frontend <name>
2803 - backend <name>
2804 - listen <name>
2805
2806A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2807its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2808section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002810
2811A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2812connections.
2813
2814A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2815to forward incoming connections.
2816
2817A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2818parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2821'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2822case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2823
2824Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2825logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2826proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2827However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2828name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2829
2830Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2831and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002832bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002833protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2834modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2835arbitrary criteria.
2836
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002837In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2838a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002839the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002840
2841 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2842 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2843 between responses and new requests.
2844
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002845 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2846 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2847 client-facing connection remains open.
2848
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002849 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2850 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002851
2852The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2853frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2854following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002855weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002856
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002857 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002858
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002859 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2860 ----+-----+-----+----
2861 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2862 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002863 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2864 ----+-----+-----+----
2865 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028694.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2870--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002872The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2873limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2874they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2875limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002876marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002877option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002878and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2879with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2880specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002882
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002883 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2884------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2885acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002886backlog X X X -
2887balance X - X X
2888bind - X X -
2889bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002890capture cookie - X X -
2891capture request header - X X -
2892capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002893clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2894clitcpka-idle X X X -
2895clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002896compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002897cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002898declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002899default-server X - X X
2900default_backend X X X -
2901description - X X X
2902disabled X X X X
2903dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002904email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002905email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002906email-alert mailers X X X X
2907email-alert myhostname X X X X
2908email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002909enabled X X X X
2910errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002911errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002912errorloc X X X X
2913errorloc302 X X X X
2914-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2915errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002916force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002917filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002918fullconn X - X X
2919grace X X X X
2920hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002921http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002922http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002923http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002924http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002925http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002926http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002927http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002928http-check set-var X - X X
2929http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002930http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002931http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002932http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002933http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002934http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002935id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002936ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002937load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002938log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002939log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002940log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002941log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002942max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002943maxconn X X X -
2944mode X X X X
2945monitor fail - X X -
2946monitor-net X X X -
2947monitor-uri X X X -
2948option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2949option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2950option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2951option allbackups (*) X - X X
2952option checkcache (*) X - X X
2953option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2954option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002955option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002956option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2957option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002958-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2959option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002960option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2961option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002962option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002963option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002964option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002965option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002966option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002967option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2968option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2969option httpchk X - X X
2970option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002971option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002972option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002973option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002974option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002975option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002976option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2977option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2978option logasap (*) X X X -
2979option mysql-check X - X X
2980option nolinger (*) X X X X
2981option originalto X X X X
2982option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002983option pgsql-check X - X X
2984option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002986option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002987option smtpchk X - X X
2988option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2989option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2990option splice-request (*) X X X X
2991option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002992option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002993option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2994option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2995-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002996option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002997option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2998option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2999option tcpka X X X X
3000option tcplog X X X X
3001option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003002external-check command X - X X
3003external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3005rate-limit sessions X X X -
3006redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003007-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003008retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003009retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003010server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003011server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003012server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003013source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003014srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3015srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3016srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003017stats admin - X X X
3018stats auth X X X X
3019stats enable X X X X
3020stats hide-version X X X X
3021stats http-request - X X X
3022stats realm X X X X
3023stats refresh X X X X
3024stats scope X X X X
3025stats show-desc X X X X
3026stats show-legends X X X X
3027stats show-node X X X X
3028stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003029-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3030stick match - - X X
3031stick on - - X X
3032stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003033stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003034stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003035tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003036tcp-check connect X - X X
3037tcp-check expect X - X X
3038tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003039tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003040tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003041tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003042tcp-check set-var X - X X
3043tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003044tcp-request connection - X X -
3045tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003046tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003047tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003048tcp-response content - - X X
3049tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050timeout check X - X X
3051timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003052timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003053timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003054timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3055timeout http-request X X X X
3056timeout queue X - X X
3057timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003058timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003059timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003060timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003062unique-id-format X X X -
3063unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003065use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003066use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003067------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3068 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3072---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
3074This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3075
3076
3077acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3078 Declare or complete an access list.
3079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3080 no | yes | yes | yes
3081 Example:
3082 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3083 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3084 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003086 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003089backlog <conns>
3090 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 yes | yes | yes | no
3093 Arguments :
3094 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3095 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003096 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003097
3098 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3099 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3100 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3101 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3102 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3103 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3104 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3105 backlog parameter.
3106
3107 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3108 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3109 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3110
3111 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3112
3113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003115balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 yes | no | yes | yes
3119 Arguments :
3120 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3121 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3122 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3123 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3124
3125 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3126 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3127 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3128 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003129 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003130 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003131 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3132 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3133 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3134 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3135 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3136 it, so that you don't worry.
3137
3138 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3139 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3140 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3141 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3142 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3143 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3144 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3145 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003146
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003147 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3148 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3149 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3150 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3151 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3152 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3153 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3154 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3155
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003156 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003157 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003158 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3159 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003160 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003161 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3162 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3163 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3164 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3165 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003166 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3167 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3168 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3169 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3170 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3171 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3174 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3175 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3176 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3177 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3178 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3179 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3180 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003181 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003183 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3184 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3185 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003187 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3188 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3189 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3190 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3191 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3192 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3193 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3194 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3195 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3196 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3197 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3198 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003200 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003201 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3202 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3203 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3204 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3205 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3206 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3207 URIs start with a leading "/".
3208
3209 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3210 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3211 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3212 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3213
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003214 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3215 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3216 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3217 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003220 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3221
3222 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003223 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3224 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003225 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3226 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3227 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3228 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003229 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003230 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3231 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003232
3233 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3234 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3235 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3236 server will receive the request.
3237
3238 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3239 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3240 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3241 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3242 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003243 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3244 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3245 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003247 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3248 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3249 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3250 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3251 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003253 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003254 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3255 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3256 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3257
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003258 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3259 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3260 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3261
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003262 random
3263 random(<draws>)
3264 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003265 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3266 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3267 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3268 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003269 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3270 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3271 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3272 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3273 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3274 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3275 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3276 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3277 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3278 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3279 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3280 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3281 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3282 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3283 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3284 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3285 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3286 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3287 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3288 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003289
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003290 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003291 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003292 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3293 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3294 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3295 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3296 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3297 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003298 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003299 used instead.
3300
3301 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3302 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3303 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3304 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3305
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003306 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3307 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3308 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3309
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003310 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003312 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003313 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3314 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003315
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003316 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3317 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3318 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003320 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003321 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003322 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3323 NTLM relies on.
3324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325 Examples :
3326 balance roundrobin
3327 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003328 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003329 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3330 balance hdr(host)
3331 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003332
3333 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3334 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003336 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003337 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3338 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3339 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003340 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003341
3342 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3343 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3344 defaults to 16 kB.
3345
3346 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3347 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3348
3349 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3350 Round Robin.
3351
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003352 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003353 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3354 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3355 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3356
3357 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3358
3359 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003360 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003361 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3362 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3363 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003365 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
3367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003368bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3369bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3372 no | yes | yes | no
3373 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003374 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3375 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3376 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3377 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003378 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003379 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3380 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3381 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3382 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3383 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3384 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003385 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003386 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3387 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003388 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3390 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003391 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003392 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3393 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003394 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003395 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3396 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3397 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3398 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3399 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3400 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3401 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003402 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3403 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3404 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003405 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3406 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3407 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3408 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003409 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3410 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3411 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003412
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003413 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3414 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003415 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3416 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3417 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003418 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3419 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3420 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3421 the range.
3422
3423 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3424 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3425 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3426 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3427 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3428 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3429 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003430 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003431 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003433 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003434 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003435 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3436 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3437 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3438 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3439 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3440 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003442 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3443 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3444 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3445 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003447 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3448 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3449 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3450 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3451 in a frontend.
3452
3453 Example :
3454 listen http_proxy
3455 bind :80,:443
3456 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003457 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003459 listen http_https_proxy
3460 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003461 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003462
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003463 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3464 bind ipv6@:80
3465 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3466 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3467
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003468 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003469 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003470
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003471 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3472 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3473 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3474 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3475 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3476
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003477 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003478 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479
3480
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003481bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003482 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 yes | yes | yes | yes
3485 Arguments :
3486 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3487 may be used to override a default value.
3488
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003489 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003490 option may be combined with other numbers.
3491
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003492 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003493 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3494 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3495 missing from all processes.
3496
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003497 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003498 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003499 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3500 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3501 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3502 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3503 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003504 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003505
3506 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3507 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3508 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3509 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3510 and 'even' instances.
3511
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003512 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3513 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3514 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3515 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003516
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003517 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3518 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3519
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003520 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3521 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3522 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3523
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003524 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3525 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3526
3527 Example :
3528 listen app_ip1
3529 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003530 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003531
3532 listen app_ip2
3533 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003534 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003535
3536 listen management
3537 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003538 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003539
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003540 listen management
3541 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3542 bind-process 1-4
3543
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003544 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003545
3546
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003547capture cookie <name> len <length>
3548 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 no | yes | yes | no
3551 Arguments :
3552 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3553 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3554 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3555 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003557
3558 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3559 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3560 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3561 right if it exceeds <length>.
3562
3563 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3564 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3565 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3566 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3567
3568 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3569 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3570 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3571
3572 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3573 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3574 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003575 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3576 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3577 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578
3579 Example:
3580 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3581
3582 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003583 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
3585
3586capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003587 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | no
3590 Arguments :
3591 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003592 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003593 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3594 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3595 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3596
3597 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3598 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3599 it exceeds <length>.
3600
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003601 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3603 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003604 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3605 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3606 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3607 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003608 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003609 environments to find where the request came from.
3610
3611 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3612 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3613 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3614 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003616 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3617 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3618 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3619 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3620 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621
3622 Example:
3623 capture request header Host len 15
3624 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003625 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003627 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 about logging.
3629
3630
3631capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003632 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3634 no | yes | yes | no
3635 Arguments :
3636 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003637 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3639 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3640 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3641
3642 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3643 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3644 it exceeds <length>.
3645
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003646 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3648 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3649 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003650 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3651 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3652 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3653 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003655 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3656 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3657 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3658 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3659 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
3661 Example:
3662 capture response header Content-length len 9
3663 capture response header Location len 15
3664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003665 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666 about logging.
3667
3668
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003669clitcpka-cnt <count>
3670 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3671 the connection on the client side.
3672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | no
3674 Arguments :
3675 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3676
3677 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3678 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003679 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3680 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003681
3682 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3683
3684
3685clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3686 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3687 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3688 client side.
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | yes | yes | no
3691 Arguments :
3692 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3693 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3694 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3695 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3696
3697 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3698 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003699 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3700 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003701
3702 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3703
3704
3705clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3706 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 yes | yes | yes | no
3709 Arguments :
3710 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3711 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3712 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3713 document.
3714
3715 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3716 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003717 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3718 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003719
3720 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3721
3722
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003723compression algo <algorithm> ...
3724compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003725compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003726 Enable HTTP compression.
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 yes | yes | yes | yes
3729 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003730 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3731 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3732 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3733
3734 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003735 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3736 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3737 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003738
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003739 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003740 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003741
3742 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3743 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3744 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3745 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3746 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003747 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003748
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003749 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3750 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3751 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3752 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3753 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3754 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3755 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003756 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003757
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003758 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003759 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003760 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3761 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3762 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3763 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3764 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003765
3766 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3767 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3768 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3769 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3770 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003771 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3772 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3773 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3774 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3775 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003776 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3777 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003778
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003779 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003780 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3781 "Accept-Encoding" header
3782 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003783 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003784 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3785 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3786 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3787 "multipart"
3788 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3789 header
3790 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3791 and later
3792 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3793 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003794 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003795
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003796 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003797
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003798 Examples :
3799 compression algo gzip
3800 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003801
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003802
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003803cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003804 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3805 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003806 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
3810 Arguments :
3811 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3812 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3813 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3814 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3815 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3816 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003817 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003818 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3819 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3820
3821 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3822 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3823 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3824 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3825 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3826 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003827 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3828 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003829 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003830 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3831 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832
3833 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003834 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003835
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003836 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003837 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003838 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003839 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003840 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3841 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3842 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3843 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3844 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3845 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3846 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847
3848 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3849 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3850 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3851 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3852 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3853 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3854 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3855 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3856 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003857 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003858 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3859 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3860 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003862 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3863 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3864 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003865 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3866 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3867 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3868 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003869 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3870 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3871 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872
3873 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3874 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3875 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3876 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3877 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3878 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3879 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3880 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3881 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3882
3883 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3884 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3885 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3886 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3887 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3888 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3889 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3890 persistence cookie in the cache.
3891 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3892
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003893 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3894 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3895 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3896 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3897 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003898 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003899 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3900 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3901 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3902 they logout.
3903
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003904 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3905 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3906 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3907 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3908
3909 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3910 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3911 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3912 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3913 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3914 this attribute.
3915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003916 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003917 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003918 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3919 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3920 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3921 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3922 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3923 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003924
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003925 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3926 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3927 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3928 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3929 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3930 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3931 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3932 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003933 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003934 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3935 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3936 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3937 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3938 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3939 the site.
3940
3941 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3942 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3943 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3944 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3945 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3946 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3947 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3948 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3949 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3950 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3951 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3952 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3953 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003954 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003955 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3956 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3957
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003958 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3959 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3960 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3961 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3962 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3963 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3964
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003965 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3966 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3967 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3968 repeated.
3969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003970 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3971 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3972 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3973 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003975 Examples :
3976 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3977 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3978 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003979 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003980
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003981 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003982
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003983
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003984declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3985 Declares a capture slot.
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 no | yes | yes | no
3988 Arguments:
3989 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3990
3991 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3992 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3993 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3994 for use in the response.
3995
3996 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003997 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003998 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3999
4000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004001default-server [param*]
4002 Change default options for a server in a backend
4003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4004 yes | no | yes | yes
4005 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004006 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4007 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4008 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4009 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004010
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004011 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004012 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4013
4014 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004017default_backend <backend>
4018 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 yes | yes | yes | no
4021 Arguments :
4022 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4023
4024 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4025 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4026 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4027 will catch all undetermined requests.
4028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029 Example :
4030
4031 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4032 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4033 default_backend dynamic
4034
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004035 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004038description <string>
4039 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 no | yes | yes | yes
4042 Arguments : string
4043
4044 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4045 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4046 it describes.
4047 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4048
4049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004050disabled
4051 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4053 yes | yes | yes | yes
4054 Arguments : none
4055
4056 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4057 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4058 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4059 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4060 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4061 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4062 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4063
4064 See also : "enabled"
4065
4066
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004067dispatch <address>:<port>
4068 Set a default server address
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004071 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004072
4073 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4074 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4075 during start-up.
4076
4077 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4078 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4079 possible with normal servers.
4080
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004081 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004082 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4083 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4084 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4085 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4086
4087 See also : "server"
4088
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004089
4090dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4091 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 yes | no | yes | yes
4094 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4095
4096 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004097 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004098 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4099 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004100 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004101 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103enabled
4104 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4106 yes | yes | yes | yes
4107 Arguments : none
4108
4109 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4110 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4111
4112 See also : "disabled"
4113
4114
4115errorfile <code> <file>
4116 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | yes | yes | yes
4119 Arguments :
4120 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004121 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004122 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123
4124 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004125 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004127 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4128 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129
4130 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4131 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4132 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4133
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004134 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4135
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004136 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4137 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4138 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4139 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4140 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4141 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4142 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4143 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4144 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004146 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4147 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4148 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004149 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004150 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4151
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004152 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004153
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004154 Example :
4155 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004156 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004157 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4158 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4159
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004160
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004161errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4162 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4163 section.
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | yes | yes | yes
4166 Arguments :
4167 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4168
4169 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004170 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004171 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004172
4173 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4174 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4175 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4176 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4177 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004178 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004179 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4180
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004181 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4182 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004183
4184 Example :
4185 errorfiles generic
4186 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4187
4188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004189errorloc <code> <url>
4190errorloc302 <code> <url>
4191 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 yes | yes | yes | yes
4194 Arguments :
4195 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004196 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004197 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004198
4199 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4200 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4201 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4202 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004203 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004204
4205 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4206 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4207 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4208
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004209 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4210
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004211 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4212 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4213 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4214 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004215 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004216 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4217 request.
4218
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004219 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004220
4221
4222errorloc303 <code> <url>
4223 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 yes | yes | yes | yes
4226 Arguments :
4227 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004228 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004229 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004230
4231 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4232 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4233 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4234 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004235 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004236
4237 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4238 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4239 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4240
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004241 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004243 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4244 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4245 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4246 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004247 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004248
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004249 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004250
4251
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004252email-alert from <emailaddr>
4253 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004254 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | yes | yes | yes
4257
4258 Arguments :
4259
4260 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4261
4262 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4263 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4264
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004265 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004266 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4267 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004268
4269
4270email-alert level <level>
4271 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4272 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 yes | yes | yes | yes
4275
4276 Arguments :
4277
4278 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4279 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4280 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4281
4282 By default level is alert
4283
4284 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4285 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4286 for the proxy.
4287
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004288 Alerts are sent when :
4289
4290 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4291 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4292 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4293 is notice or lower
4294 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4295 and a health check status update occurs
4296
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004297 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4298 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004299 section 3.6 about mailers.
4300
4301
4302email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4303 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 yes | yes | yes | yes
4306
4307 Arguments :
4308
4309 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4310
4311 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4312 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4313
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004314 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4315 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004316
4317
4318email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4319 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4320 mailers.
4321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 yes | yes | yes | yes
4323
4324 Arguments :
4325
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004326 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004327
4328 By default the systems hostname is used.
4329
4330 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4331 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4332 for the proxy.
4333
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004334 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4335 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004336
4337
4338email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004339 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004340 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4342 yes | yes | yes | yes
4343
4344 Arguments :
4345
4346 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4347
4348 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4349 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4350
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004351 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004352 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4353
4354
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004355force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4356 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004358 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004359
4360 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4361 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4362 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4363 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4364 marked down for maintenance operations.
4365
4366 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4367 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4368 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4369 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4370 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4371 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4372 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4373 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4374 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4375
4376 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4377 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4378 is used.
4379
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004380 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004381 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004382
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004383
4384filter <name> [param*]
4385 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4387 no | yes | yes | yes
4388 Arguments :
4389 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4390 referenced in section 9.
4391
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004392 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004393 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004394 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4395 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004396
4397 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4398 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4399
4400 Example:
4401 listen
4402 bind *:80
4403
4404 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4405 filter compression
4406 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4407
4408 compression algo gzip
4409 compression offload
4410
4411 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4412
4413 See also : section 9.
4414
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004415
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004416fullconn <conns>
4417 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | no | yes | yes
4420 Arguments :
4421 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4422 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4423
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004424 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004425 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004426 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004427 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4428 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4429 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4430 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4431 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004432 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004433
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004434 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4435 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004436 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4437 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4438 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004440 Example :
4441 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4442 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4443 # connections.
4444 backend dynamic
4445 fullconn 10000
4446 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4447 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4448
4449 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4450
4451
4452grace <time>
4453 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004455 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 Arguments :
4457 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4458 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4459 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4460
4461 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4462 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004463 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004464 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4465
4466 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4467 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4468 simplify it.
4469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004471hash-balance-factor <factor>
4472 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4474 yes | no | no | yes
4475 Arguments :
4476 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4477 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004478 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004479
4480 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4481 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4482 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4483 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4484 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4485 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4486 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4487
4488 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4489 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4490 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4491 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4492 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4493
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004494 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4495 consistent hashing mechanism.
4496
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004497 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4498
4499
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004500hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004501 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004505 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4506 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004507
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004508 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4509 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4510 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4511 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4512 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4513 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4514 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4515 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4516 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4517 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004518
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004519 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4520 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4521 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4522 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4523 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4524 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4525 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4526 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4527 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4528 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4529 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4530 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4531 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004532 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4533 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004534
4535 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4536
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004537 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004538 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4539 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4540 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004541 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4542 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4543 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004544
4545 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4546 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004547 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4548 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4549 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4550 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4551
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004552 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4553 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4554 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4555 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4556 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4557 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4558 parameter.
4559
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004560 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4561 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4562 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4563 used on strings.
4564
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004565 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4566
4567 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4568 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4569 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4570 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4571 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4572 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4573 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4574 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4575 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4576 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4577 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4578 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004579
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004580 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4581 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4582 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004583
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004584 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004585
4586
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004587http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4588 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4589 ones).
4590
4591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4592 no | yes | yes | yes
4593
4594 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4595 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4596 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4597 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4598 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4599 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4600
4601 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4602 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4603 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4604
4605 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4606 below.
4607
4608 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4609 instance.
4610
4611 Example:
4612 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4613 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4614 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4615
4616http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4617
4618 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4619 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4620 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4621 example, or to pass some internal information.
4622 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4623 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4624 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4625
4626http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4627
4628 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4629 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4630
4631http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4632
4633 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4634
4635http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4636 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4637
4638 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4639
4640 Example:
4641 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4642
4643 # applied to:
4644 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4645
4646 # outputs:
4647 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4648
4649 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4650
4651http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4652 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4653
4654 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4655
4656 Example:
4657 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4658
4659 # applied to:
4660 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4661
4662 # outputs:
4663 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4664
4665http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4666
4667 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4668 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4669 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4670
4671http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4672 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4673
4674 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4675 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4676 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4677 fallback.
4678
4679 Example:
4680 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4681 http-response set-status 431
4682 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4683 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4684
4685http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4686
4687 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4688 inline.
4689
4690 Arguments:
4691 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4692 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4696 (request and response)
4697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4698 processing
4699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4700 processing
4701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4702 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4703 and '_'.
4704
4705 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4706 followed by some converters.
4707
4708 Example:
4709 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4710
4711http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4712
4713 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4714 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4715 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4716 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4717 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004718 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004719 processing.
4720
4721 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4722 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004723 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004724 rules evaluation.
4725
4726http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4727
4728 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4729 details about <var-name>.
4730
4731 Example:
4732 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4733
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004734
4735http-check comment <string>
4736 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4737 it fails.
4738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4739 yes | no | yes | yes
4740
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004741 Arguments :
4742 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4743 rule fails.
4744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004745 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4746 user-friendly error reporting.
4747
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004748 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004749 "http-check expect".
4750
4751
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004752http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4753 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004754 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004755 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4757 yes | no | yes | yes
4758
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004759 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004760 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4761
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004762 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004763 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004764
4765 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4766 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4767 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4768 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4769
4770 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4771
4772 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4773
4774 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4775
4776 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4777
4778 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4779
4780 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4781 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4782 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4783 is used.
4784
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004785 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4786 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4787 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4788 haproxy -vv.
4789
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004790 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4791
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004792 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4793 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4794 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4795 different ports or with different servers.
4796
4797 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4798 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4799 the port with a "http-check connect".
4800
4801 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4802 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4803 do.
4804
4805 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4806 unset-var or comment rules.
4807
4808 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004809 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4810 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4811 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4812 option httpchk
4813
4814 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004815 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004816 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004817 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004818 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004819 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004820
4821 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4822
4823 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004824
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004825
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004826http-check disable-on-404
4827 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004829 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004830 Arguments : none
4831
4832 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4833 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4834 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4835 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4836 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4837 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4838 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4839 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004840 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4841 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4842 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4843
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004844 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004845
4846
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004847http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004848 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4849 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4850 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004851 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004853 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004854
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004855 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004856 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004858 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4859 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4860 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4861 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4862 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4863 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4864 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4865 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4866 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4867 result is always conclusive.
4868
4869 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4870 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4871 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004872 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4873 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4874 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4875 example 404 with disable-on-404
4876 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4877 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4878 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004879
4880 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4881 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004882 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4883 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4884 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4885 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4886 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4887 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004888
4889 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4890 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004891 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4892 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4893 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4894 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004895 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4896
4897 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4898 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4899 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4900 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4901
4902 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4903 informational message reported in logs if an error
4904 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4905 log-format string.
4906
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004907 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004908 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4909 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004910 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4911 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4912 details on the supported keywords.
4913
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004914 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4915 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4916 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4917 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004918
4919 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4920 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4921 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4922 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4923 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4924
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004925 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4926 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4927 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4928 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4929 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4930 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4931 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004932
4933 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004934 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004935 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4936 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4937 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4938 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4939
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004940 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4941 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004942 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4943 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4944 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4945 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4946 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4947 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4948 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4949 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004950 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4951 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4952 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4953 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4954 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4955 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4956 insensitive on the header names.
4957
4958 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4959 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4960 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4961 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4962 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4963 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004964
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004965 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004966 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004967 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4968 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4969 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4970 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4971 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004972 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004973 trace).
4974
4975 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004976 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004977 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4978 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4979 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4980 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4981 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004982 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004983
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004984 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4985 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4986 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4987 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4988 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4989 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4990
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004991 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4992 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4993 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4994 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4995 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4996 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4997 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4998 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4999
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005000 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5001 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5002 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5003 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5004 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005005
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005006 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5007 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5008
5009 Examples :
5010 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005011 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005012
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005013 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5014 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5015
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005016 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005017 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005018
5019 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005020 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005021
5022 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005023 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005024
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005025 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005026 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005027
5028
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005029http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005030 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5031 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005032 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5033 health checks.
5034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5035 yes | no | yes | yes
5036 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005037 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5038
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005039 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5040 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5041 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5042 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5043 to invent non-standard ones.
5044
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005045 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5046 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5047 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5048 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5049
5050 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5051 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5052 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5053 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005054
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005055 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005056 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005057 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005058 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5059 to add it.
5060
5061 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5062 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5063 to the log-format rules.
5064
5065 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5066 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5067 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005068
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005069 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5070 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5071 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5072 request.
5073
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005074 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5075 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5076 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005077 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5078 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5079 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5080 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005081 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005082 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005083 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5084
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005085 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5086 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005087 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5088 so, it will be ignored.
5089
5090 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5091 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5092 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5093 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5094 configured request authority.
5095
5096 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5097 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005098
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005099 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005100
5101
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005102http-check send-state
5103 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5105 yes | no | yes | yes
5106 Arguments : none
5107
5108 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5109 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5110 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5111 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5112 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5113
5114 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5115 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5116 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5117 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5118 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005119 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5120 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5121 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5122
5123 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5124 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5125 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5126
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005127 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5128 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5129 checked in multiple backends.
5130
5131 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5132 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5133
5134 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5135 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5136 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5137 one fails.
5138
5139 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5140 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5141 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5142
5143 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5144 server's queue.
5145
5146 Example of a header received by the application server :
5147 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5148 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5149
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005150 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5151 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005152
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005153
5154http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005155 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | no | yes | yes
5158
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005159 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005160 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5161 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5162 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5163 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5164 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5165 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5166 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5167 and '-'.
5168
5169 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5170
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005171 Examples :
5172 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173
5174
5175http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005176 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5178 yes | no | yes | yes
5179
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005180 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005181 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5182 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5185 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5187 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5188 and '-'.
5189
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005190 Examples :
5191 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005193
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005194http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5195 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5196 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5197 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5198 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | yes | yes | yes
5201 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005202 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005203 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005204 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5205 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005206
5207 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5208 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5209 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5210 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5211
5212 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5213 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5214 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5215 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5216
5217 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5218 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5219 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5220 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5221 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5222 chroot is performed.
5223
5224 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5225 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5226 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5227 considered.
5228
5229 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5230 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5231 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5232 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5233 considered as a raw string.
5234
5235 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5236 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5237 "content-type".
5238
5239 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5240 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5241 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5242 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5243 evaluated as a log-format string.
5244
5245 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5246 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5247 argument to "content-type".
5248
5249 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5250 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5251 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5252 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5253
5254 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5255 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5256 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5257 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5258 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5259 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5260 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5261 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5262
5263 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5264 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5265 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5266
5267 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5268 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5269
5270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005271http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005272 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5273
5274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 no | yes | yes | yes
5276
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005277 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5278 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5279 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5280 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5281 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005283 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5284 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005286 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 Example:
5289 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5290 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5291 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005293 http-request allow if nagios
5294 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5295 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5296 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298 Example:
5299 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5300 acl add path /addacl
5301 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005303 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005305 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5306 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005308 Example:
5309 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5310 acl setmap path /setmap
5311 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5316 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5319 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005321http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5324 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5325 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5326 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5327 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5328 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5329 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5330 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005332http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5335 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5336 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5337 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5338 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5339 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5340 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5341 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005345 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5346 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005347
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5352 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5353 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5354 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5355 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005356
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005357 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5358 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5359 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5360 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5361 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5362 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5363 instead.
5364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365 Example:
5366 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5367 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005368
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005369http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005371 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005373http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005376 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5377 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5378 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5379 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5380 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5381 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5382 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5383 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5384 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5387 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5388 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005389 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5390
5391 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5392 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5393 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5394 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005396http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005398 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5399 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5400 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5401 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5402 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5403 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005405http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005407 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005409http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005411 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5412 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5413 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5414 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5415 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5416 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005417
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005418http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5419http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5420 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5421 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5422 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005424
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005425 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5426 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5427 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005428 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005429 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5430 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5431 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005433 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005434
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005435http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5436 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5437 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5438 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5439
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005440http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5441
5442 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5443 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5444 pointed by <resolvers>.
5445 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5446 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5447 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5448 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5449 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5450 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5451 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5452 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5453 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5454 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5455 to 0.0.0.0.
5456
5457 Example:
5458 resolvers mydns
5459 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5460 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5461 timeout retry 1s
5462 hold valid 10s
5463 hold nx 3s
5464 hold other 3s
5465 hold obsolete 0s
5466 accepted_payload_size 8192
5467
5468 frontend fe
5469 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5470 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5471 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5472
5473 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5474 # which mean DNS resolution error
5475 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5476
5477 default_backend be
5478
5479 backend b_503
5480 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5481 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5482 # 503 error page to end users
5483
5484 backend be
5485 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5486 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5487 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5488 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5489 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5490
5491 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5492 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5493
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005494http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5495
5496 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5497 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5498 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5499 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005500 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5501 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005502
5503 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005505http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005507 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5508 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5509 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5510 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5511 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005513http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005515 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5516 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5517 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5518 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005520http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005522
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005523 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005524 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5525 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5526 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5527 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5528 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005529
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005530 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5531 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5532 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5533 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5534 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005535
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005536 Example:
5537 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5538
5539 # applied to:
5540 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5541
5542 # outputs:
5543 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5544
5545 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005546
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005547 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5548
5549 # applied to:
5550 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005551
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005552 # outputs:
5553 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005554
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005555http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5556 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5557
5558 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5559 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005560 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5561 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5562 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005563
5564 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5565 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5566 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5567
5568 Example:
5569 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5570 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5571
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005572 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5573 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5574 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5575 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5576
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005577http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5579
5580 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5581 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5582 query-string are replaced.
5583
5584 Example:
5585 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5586 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5587
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005588http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5590
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005591 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5592 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5593 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5594 against.
5595
5596 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5597 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5598 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005599
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005600 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5601 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5602 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5603 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5604 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5605 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5606 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5607 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5608 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005609 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5610 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005611
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005612 Example:
5613 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5614 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005615
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005616 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5617 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005619http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005621
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005622 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5623 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5624 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5625 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005626
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005627 Example:
5628 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005629
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005630 # applied to:
5631 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005632
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005633 # outputs:
5634 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005635
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005636http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5637 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5638 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005639 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5641
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005642 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005643 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5644 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005645 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005646 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005647 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005648 are followed to create the response :
5649
5650 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5651 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5652 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5653 ignored.
5654
5655 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5656 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005657 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005658 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5659 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005660
5661 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5662 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5663 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005664 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005665 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005666
5667 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5668 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5669 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005670 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005671 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5672 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005673
5674 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5675 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5676 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5677 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5678 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5679 as a raw content.
5680
5681 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5682 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5683 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5684 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5685 considered as a raw string.
5686
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005687 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5688 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5689 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5690 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5691
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005692 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5693 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005694 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005695
5696 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5697
5698 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005699 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005700 if { path /ping }
5701
5702 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5703 if { path /favicon.ico }
5704
5705 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5706 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5707 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005709http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5710http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005712 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5713 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5714 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005715
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005716http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005718
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005719 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5720 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5721 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5722 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5727 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5728 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5729 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5730 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005732 Arguments:
5733 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5734 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005736 Example:
5737 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5738 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005740 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5741 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005745 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5746 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5747 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005749 Arguments:
5750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5751 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753 Example:
5754 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5755 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005757 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5758 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5759 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005761http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005763 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5764 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5765 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5766 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5767 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769 Example:
5770 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5771 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5772 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5773 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5774 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5775 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5776 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5777 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5778 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005780http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5783 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5784 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5785 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5786 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5789 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5792 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5793 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5794 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5795 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5796 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5797 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5798 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5799 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005801http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5804 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5805 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5806 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5807 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5808 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5809 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5814 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5815 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005819 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5820 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5821 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5822 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5823 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5824 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5825 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5826 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5831 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5832 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5833 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5834 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5835 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837 Example :
5838 # prepend the host name before the path
5839 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005840
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005841http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5842
5843 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5844 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5845 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005849 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5850 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5851 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5852 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5853 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5858 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5859 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5860 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5861 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5862 values have higher priority.
5863 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5864 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5865 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5866 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5867 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005871 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5872 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5873 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5874 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5875 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5876 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5877 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005879 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005880
5881 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005882 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5883 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005885http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5886 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5887 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5888 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005889 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5890 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891
5892 Arguments :
5893 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5894 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005895
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005896 See also "option forwardfor".
5897
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005898 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5900 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5901
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005902 # After the masking this will track connections
5903 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5904 http-request track-sc0 src
5905
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005906 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5907 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5908
5909http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5910
5911 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5912 expression.
5913
5914 Arguments:
5915 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5916 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005917
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005918 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005919 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5920 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5921
5922 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5923 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5924 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5925
5926http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5927
5928 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5929 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5930 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5931 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5932 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5933 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5934 information from the request.
5935
5936 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5937
5938http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5939
5940 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5941 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5942 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5943 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5944 path and the query string.
5945 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5946
5947http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5948
5949 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5950 inline.
5951
5952 Arguments:
5953 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5954 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5957 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5958 (request and response)
5959 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5960 processing
5961 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5962 processing
5963 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5964 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5965 and '_'.
5966
5967 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5968 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005969
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005970 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005976 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5977 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5978 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5979 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5980 agent name must be used.
5981
5982 Arguments:
5983 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5984
5985 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5986 configuration.
5987
5988http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5989
5990 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5991 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5992 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5993 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5994 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5995 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5996 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5997 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5998 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5999 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6000 action.
6001 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6002 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6003 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6004 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6005 you fully understand how it works.
6006
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006007http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6008
6009 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6010 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6011 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6012 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6013 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006014 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006015 processing.
6016
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006017 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006018 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6019 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6020 rules evaluation.
6021
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006022http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6023http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6024 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6025 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6026 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6027 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006028
6029 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6030 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6031 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006032 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6033 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6034 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6035 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6036 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6037 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6038 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6039 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6040 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6041 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006042 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006043 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6044 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6045 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6046 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6047 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048
6049http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6050http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6051http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6052
6053 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6054 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6055 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6056 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6057 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6058 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6059 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6060 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6061 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6062 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6063 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6064 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6065
6066 Arguments :
6067 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6068 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6069 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6070 select which table entry to update the counters.
6071
6072 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6073 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6074 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6075 that table until the session ends.
6076
6077 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6078 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6079 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6080 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6081 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6082 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6083 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6084 useful information.
6085
6086 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6087 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6088 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6089 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6090 checks that make use of it.
6091
6092http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6093
6094 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006095
6096 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006098
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006099http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6100
6101 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6102 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6103 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6104 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6105 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6106 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6107
6108 Arguments :
6109 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6110
6111 Example:
6112 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006116 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6117 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6118 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006119
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006121http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006122 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6123
6124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 no | yes | yes | yes
6126
6127 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6128 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6129 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6130 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6131 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6132 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006134 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6135 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006137 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006139 Example:
6140 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006142 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006144 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6145 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006147 Example:
6148 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006150 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006152 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6153 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006155 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6156 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006158http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006160 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6161 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6162 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6163 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6164 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6165 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6166 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6167 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006169http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006171 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6172 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6173 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6174 example, or to pass some internal information.
6175 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6176 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6177 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006179http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006181 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6182 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006183
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006184http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006185
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006186 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006188http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006190 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6191 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6192 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6193 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6194 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6195 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6196 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6199 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6200 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6201 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6202 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006203
6204 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6205 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6206 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6207 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006209http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6212 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6213 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6214 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6215 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6216 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006218http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006220 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006222http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006224 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6225 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6226 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6227 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6228 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6229 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006230
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006231http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6232http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6233 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6234 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6235 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006237
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006238 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6239 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6240 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006241 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006242 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6243 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6244 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006245 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006246 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006248http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006250 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6251 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6252 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6253 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6254 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6255 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006257http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006259
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006260 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6261 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006263 Example:
6264 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006266 # applied to:
6267 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006269 # outputs:
6270 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006272 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006274http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006276
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006277 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006278 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006280 Example:
6281 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006282
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006283 # applied to:
6284 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006286 # outputs:
6287 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006288
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006289http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6290 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6291 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006292 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6294
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006295 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006296 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6297 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006298 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006299 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006300 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006301 are followed to create the response :
6302
6303 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6304 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6305 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6306 ignored.
6307
6308 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6309 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006310 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006311 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6312 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006313
6314 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6315 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6316 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006317 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006318 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006319
6320 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6321 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6322 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006323 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006324 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6325 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006326
6327 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6328 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6329 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6330 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6331 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6332 as a raw content.
6333
6334 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6335 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6336 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6337 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6338 considered as a raw string.
6339
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006340 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6341 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6342 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6343 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6344
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006345 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6346 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006347 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006348
6349 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6350
6351 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006353 if { status eq 404 }
6354
6355 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6356 string "This is the end !" \
6357 if { status eq 500 }
6358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006359http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006362 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6363 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6364 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006365
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006366http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6367 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006368
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006369 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6370 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6371 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6372 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006373
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006374http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006376 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6377 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6378 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6379 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6380 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006381
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006382 Arguments:
6383 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006385 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6386 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006388http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006389
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006390 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6391 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6392 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006394http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6395
6396 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6397 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6398 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6399 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6400 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6401
6402http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6403
6404 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6405 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6406 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6407 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6408 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6409 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6410 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6411 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6412 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6413
6414http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6415
6416 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6417 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6418 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6419 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6420 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6421 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6422 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6423
6424http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6425
6426 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6427 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6428 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6429 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6430 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6431 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6432 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6433 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6434
6435http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6439 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6440 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6441 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006442
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006443 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6445 http-response set-status 431
6446 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6447 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006451 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6452 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6453 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6454 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6455 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6456 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6457 based on some information from the request.
6458
6459 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6460
6461http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6462
6463 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6464 inline.
6465
6466 Arguments:
6467 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6468 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6469 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6470 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6471 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6472 (request and response)
6473 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6474 processing
6475 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6476 processing
6477 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6478 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6479 and '_'.
6480
6481 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6482 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006483
6484 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006485 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006487http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006489 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6490 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6491 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6492 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6493 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6494 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6495 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6496 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6497 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6498 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6499 action.
6500 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6501 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6502 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6503 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6504 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006505
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006506http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6507
6508 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6509 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6510 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6511 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6512 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006513 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006514 processing.
6515
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006516 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006517 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006518 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006519 rules evaluation.
6520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006521http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6522http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6523http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006524
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006525 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6526 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6527 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6528 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6529 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6530 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6531
6532http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6533
6534 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6535 about <var-name>.
6536
6537 Example:
6538 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6539
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006540
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006541http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6542 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6543
6544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6545 yes | no | yes | yes
6546
6547 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006548 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6549 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6550 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006551
6552 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6553
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006554 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6555 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6556 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6557 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6558 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6559 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6560 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6561 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6562 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6563 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006564
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006565 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6566 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6567 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6568 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6569 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6570 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6571 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6572 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006573
6574 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6575 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6576 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6577 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6578 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6579 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6580 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6581 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006582 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006583 downsides of rare connection failures.
6584
6585 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6586 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6587 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6588 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6589 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6590 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006591 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006592 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6593 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6594 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6595 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6596 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6597
6598 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006599 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6600 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6601 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006602
6603 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006604 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006605
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006606 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6607 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006608
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006609 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006610
6611 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6612 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6613 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6614
6615 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6616
6617
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006618http-send-name-header [<header>]
6619 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006622 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006623 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6624
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006625 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6626 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6627 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6628 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6629 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6630 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6631 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6632 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6633 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6634 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6635 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6636 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6637 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6638 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6639 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6640 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006641
6642 See also : "server"
6643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006644id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006645 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 no | yes | yes | yes
6648 Arguments : none
6649
6650 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6651 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6652 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006653
6654
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006655ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6656 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006658 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006659
6660 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6661 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6662 and running).
6663
6664 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6665 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6666 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006667 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006668 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6669
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006670 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6671 "unless" condition is met.
6672
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006673 Example:
6674 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6675 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6676 ignore-persist if url_static
6677
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006678 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6679
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006680load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6681 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | no | yes | yes
6684
6685 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6686 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6687 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006688 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006689 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6690 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6691 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6692 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6693
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006694 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006695 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006696 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006697
6698 Arguments:
6699 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6700 named "server-state-file".
6701
6702 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6703 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6704 name is used as a file name.
6705
6706 none don't load any stat for this backend
6707
6708 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006709 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6710 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6711 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006712 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006713 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006714
6715 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6716 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6717
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006718 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006719
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006720 global
6721 stats socket /tmp/socket
6722 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006723
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006724 defaults
6725 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006726
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006727 backend bk
6728 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6729 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006730
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006731
6732 Then one can run :
6733
6734 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6735
6736 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6737
6738 1
6739 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6740 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6741 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6742
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006743 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006744
6745 global
6746 stats socket /tmp/socket
6747 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6748
6749 defaults
6750 load-server-state-from-file local
6751
6752 backend bk
6753 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6754 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6755
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006756
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006757 Then one can run :
6758
6759 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6760
6761 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6762
6763 1
6764 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6765 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6766 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6767
6768 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6769 "show servers state"
6770
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006771
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006772log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006773log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6774 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006775no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006776 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006779
6780 Prefix :
6781 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6782 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6783 prefix does not allow arguments.
6784
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006785 Arguments :
6786 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6787 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6788 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6789 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6790 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6791 parameter.
6792
6793 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6794 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6795
6796 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6797 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6798 standard syslog port).
6799
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006800 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6801 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6802 standard syslog port).
6803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006804 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6805 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6806 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006807 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006808
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006809 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6810 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6811 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6812 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6813 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6814 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6815 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6816 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6817 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6818 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6819 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6820 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6821 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6822 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6823 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6824 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006825 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6826 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006827
6828 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6829 and "fd@2", see above.
6830
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006831 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6832 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6833 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6834 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6835 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6836 having the logs instantly available.
6837
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006838 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6839 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006840
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006841 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6842 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6843 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6844 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6845 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6846 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6847 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6848 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6849 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6850 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006852
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006853 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6854 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6855 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6856 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6857 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6858
6859 <sample_size>
6860 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6861 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6862 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6863 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6864 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6865
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006866 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6867 one of the following :
6868
6869 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6870 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6871
6872 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6873 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6874
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006875 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6876 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6877 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6878 designed to be used with a local log server.
6879
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006880 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6881 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6882 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6883 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6884 systemd logger consumes.
6885
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006886 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6887 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6888 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6889 used with a local log server.
6890
6891 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6892 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6893 designed to be used with a local log server.
6894
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006895 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6896 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6897 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6898 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006900 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6901
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006902 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6903 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6904 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6905
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006906 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6907 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6908 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6909 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006910
6911 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6912 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6913 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006914 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6915 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6916 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6917 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6918 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006919
6920 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6921
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006922 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6923 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6924 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006925
6926 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6927 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6928 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6929 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6930
6931 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6932 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006933
6934 Example :
6935 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006936 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6937 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6938 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006939 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6940 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006941 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006943
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006944log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006945 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6947 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006948
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006949 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6950 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6951 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6952 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6953 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006954
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006955 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6956 "option httplog" directives.
6957
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006958log-format-sd <string>
6959 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 yes | yes | yes | no
6962
6963 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6964 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6965 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6966 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6967 which covers the log format string in depth.
6968
6969 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6970 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6971
6972 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6973 log format to "rfc5424".
6974
6975 Example :
6976 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6977
6978
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006979log-tag <string>
6980 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6982 yes | yes | yes | yes
6983
6984 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6985 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6986 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6987 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6988 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6989 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6990 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6991 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6992 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006993
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006994max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6995 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 yes | no | yes | yes
6998
6999 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7000 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7001 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7002 servers.
7003
7004 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7005 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7006 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7007 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7008 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007009 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007010 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7011 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7012 picking a different server.
7013
7014 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7015 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7016 even if they have to be queued.
7017
7018 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7019 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7020
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007021max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7022 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7023 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7024 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007026maxconn <conns>
7027 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 yes | yes | yes | no
7030 Arguments :
7031 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7032 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7033 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7034 closes.
7035
7036 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7037 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7038 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7039 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007040 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7041 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7042 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7043 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007044
7045 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7046 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7047 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7048
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007049 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7050 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007052 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7053
7054
7055mode { tcp|http|health }
7056 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7058 yes | yes | yes | yes
7059 Arguments :
7060 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7061 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7062 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7063 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7064
7065 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7066 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7067 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7068 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7069 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7070
7071 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007072 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
7073 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
7074 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
7075 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
7076 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
7077 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
7078 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007079
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007080 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7081 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7082 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007083
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007084 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007085 defaults http_instances
7086 mode http
7087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007088 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007090
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007091monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007092 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7094 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007095 Arguments :
7096 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7097 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007098 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007099 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7100 backend and its backup.
7101
7102 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7103 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7104 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7105 servers in a list of backends.
7106
7107 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7108 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7109 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7110 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7111 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7112 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7113 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007114 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7115 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007116
7117 Example:
7118 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007119 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007120 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7121 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7122 monitor-uri /site_alive
7123 monitor fail if site_dead
7124
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007125 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007126
7127
7128monitor-net <source>
7129 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | yes | yes | no
7132 Arguments :
7133 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7134 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7135 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7136 followed by a mask.
7137
7138 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7139 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007140 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007141 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7142
7143 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7144 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7145 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7146 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007147 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7148 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7149 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007150
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007151 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7152 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7153 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7154 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7155 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7156 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007157
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007158 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7159 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007160
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007161 Example :
7162 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7163 frontend www
7164 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7165
7166 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7167
7168
7169monitor-uri <uri>
7170 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7172 yes | yes | yes | no
7173 Arguments :
7174 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7175 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7176
7177 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7178 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7179 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7180 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7181 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7182 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7183 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7184 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7185
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007186 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007187 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7188 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7189 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7190 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7191 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7192 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007193
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007194 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7195 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7196 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7197 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7198
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007199 Example :
7200 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7201 frontend www
7202 mode http
7203 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7204
7205 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007207
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007208option abortonclose
7209no option abortonclose
7210 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 yes | no | yes | yes
7213 Arguments : none
7214
7215 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7216 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7217 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7218 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007219 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007220 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7221 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7222 encountered while delivering the response.
7223
7224 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7225 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7226 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7227 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7228 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7229 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007230 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007231 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007232 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007233 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7234 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7235 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7236
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007237 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7238 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007239 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7240 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7241 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7242 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7243 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7244 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007245 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007246
7247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7249
7250 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7251
7252
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007253option accept-invalid-http-request
7254no option accept-invalid-http-request
7255 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 yes | yes | yes | no
7258 Arguments : none
7259
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007260 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007261 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007262 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007263 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7264 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7265 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7266 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7267 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007268 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7269 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7270 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7271 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007272 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007273 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007274 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7275 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7276 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007277
7278 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7279 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7280 been confirmed.
7281
7282 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7283 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007284 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7285 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007286 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7287
7288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7290
7291 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7292 stats socket.
7293
7294
7295option accept-invalid-http-response
7296no option accept-invalid-http-response
7297 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | no | yes | yes
7300 Arguments : none
7301
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007302 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007303 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007304 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007305 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7306 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7307 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7308 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7309 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007310 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7311 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7312 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007313
7314 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7315 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7316 been confirmed.
7317
7318 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7319 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7320 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7321 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7322
7323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7325
7326 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7327 stats socket.
7328
7329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007330option allbackups
7331no option allbackups
7332 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 yes | no | yes | yes
7335 Arguments : none
7336
7337 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7338 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7339 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7340 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7341 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7342 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7343 order between the backup servers anymore.
7344
7345 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7346 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7347
7348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7350
7351
7352option checkcache
7353no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007354 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7356 yes | no | yes | yes
7357 Arguments : none
7358
7359 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7360 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007361 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007362 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7363 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007364 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007365
7366 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007367 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007368 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007369 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7370 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007371 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007372 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007373 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7374 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007375 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007376 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7377 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007378 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007379 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7380 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7381 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7382 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7383 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7384 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7385 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7386 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7387 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7388
7389 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007390 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7391 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7392 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7393 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007394
7395 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7396 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007397 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007398 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007399
7400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7402
7403
7404option clitcpka
7405no option clitcpka
7406 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 yes | yes | yes | no
7409 Arguments : none
7410
7411 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7412 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007413 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007414 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7415
7416 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7417 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7418 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7419 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7420
7421 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7422 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7423 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7424 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7425 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7426
7427 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7428
7429 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7430 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7431 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7437
7438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007439option contstats
7440 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 yes | yes | yes | no
7443 Arguments : none
7444
7445 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7446 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7447 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7448 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007449 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7450 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7451 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7452 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7453 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007454
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007455option disable-h2-upgrade
7456no option disable-h2-upgrade
7457 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7458 connection.
7459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7460 yes | yes | yes | no
7461 Arguments : none
7462
7463 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7464 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7465 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7466 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7467 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7468 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7469 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7470 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7471
7472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007474
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007475option dontlog-normal
7476no option dontlog-normal
7477 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 yes | yes | yes | no
7480 Arguments : none
7481
7482 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7483 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7484 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7485 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7486 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7487 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7488 logged.
7489
7490 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7491 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7492 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007494 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007495 logging.
7496
7497
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007498option dontlognull
7499no option dontlognull
7500 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | yes | yes | no
7503 Arguments : none
7504
7505 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7506 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7507 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7508 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7509 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7510 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007511 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7512 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7513 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007514
7515 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007517 would not be logged.
7518
7519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7521
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007522 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7523 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007524
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007525
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007526option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007527 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 yes | yes | yes | yes
7530 Arguments :
7531 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7532 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007533 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007534 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007535
7536 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7537 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7538 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7539 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7540 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7541 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7542 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007543 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7544 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7545 possible that the client has already brought one.
7546
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007547 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007548 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007549 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007550 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007551 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007552 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007553
7554 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7555 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7556 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7557 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7558 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7559 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7560 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7561
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007562 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7563 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7564 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7565 are under the control of the end-user.
7566
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007567 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007568 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7569 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007570 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7571 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7572 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007573
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007574 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007575 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7576 frontend www
7577 mode http
7578 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7579
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007580 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7581 backend www
7582 mode http
7583 option forwardfor header X-Client
7584
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007585 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007586 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007587
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007588
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007589option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7590no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7591 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 yes | yes | yes | no
7594 Arguments : none
7595
7596 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7597 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7598 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7599 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7600 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7601 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7602 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7603
7604 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7605 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7606 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7607 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7608 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7609 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7610 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7611 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7612 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7613 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7614
7615 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7616
7617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7619
7620 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7621 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7622
7623
7624option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7625no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7626 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7628 yes | no | yes | yes
7629 Arguments : none
7630
7631 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7632 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7633 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7634 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7635 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7636 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7637 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7638
7639 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7640 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7641 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7642 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7643 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7644 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7645 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7646 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7647 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7648 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7649
7650 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7651
7652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7654
7655 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7656 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7657
7658
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007659option http-buffer-request
7660no option http-buffer-request
7661 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | yes | yes | yes
7664 Arguments : none
7665
7666 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7667 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7668 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7669 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7670 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7671 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007672 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7673 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7674 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7675 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007676
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007677 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007678
7679
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007680option http-ignore-probes
7681no option http-ignore-probes
7682 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7684 yes | yes | yes | no
7685 Arguments : none
7686
7687 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7688 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7689 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7690 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7691 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7692 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7693 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7694 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7695 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007696 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7697 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007698 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7699
7700 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7701 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7702 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7703 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7704 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7705 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7706 are often the only way to detect them.
7707
7708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7710
7711 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7712
7713
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007714option http-keep-alive
7715no option http-keep-alive
7716 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | yes | yes | yes
7719 Arguments : none
7720
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007721 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7722 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007723 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7724 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007725 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7726 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7727 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007728
7729 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7730 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007731 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7732 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7733 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7734 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7735 situations where this option may be useful :
7736
7737 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007738 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007739
7740 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7741 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7742
7743 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7744 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7745 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7746 request.
7747
7748 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7749 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007750 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7751 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7752 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007753
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007754 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7755 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7756 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7757 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7758 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7759 not set.
7760
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007761 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7762 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7763 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007764
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007765 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007766 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007767 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007768
7769
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007770option http-no-delay
7771no option http-no-delay
7772 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | yes
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7778 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7779 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7780 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7781 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7782 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7783 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7784 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7785 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7786 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7787 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7788 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7789 affected.
7790
7791 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7792 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7793 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7794 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7795 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7796 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7797 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7798 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7799 latency environments.
7800
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007801 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7802
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007803
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007804option http-pretend-keepalive
7805no option http-pretend-keepalive
7806 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007809 Arguments : none
7810
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007811 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007812 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7813 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7814 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7815 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7816 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7817 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7818 consider the response complete.
7819
7820 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7821 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7822 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7823 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007824 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007825 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7826
7827 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7828 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7829 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7830 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7831 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7832 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7833 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7834
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007835 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7836 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7837 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7838 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7839 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7840 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007841
7842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7844
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007845 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007846 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007847
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007848
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007849option http-server-close
7850no option http-server-close
7851 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 yes | yes | yes | yes
7854 Arguments : none
7855
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007856 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7857 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7858 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7859 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007860 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7861 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7862 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7863 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7864 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7865 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7866 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7867 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7868 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7869 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7870 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007871
7872 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7873 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7874 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7875 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007876 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7877 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007878
7879 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7880 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007881 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7882 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7883 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007884
7885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7887
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007888 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7889 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007890
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007891option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007892no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007893 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 yes | yes | yes | no
7896 Arguments : none
7897
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007898 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007899 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7900 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7901 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7902 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7903 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7904 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7905
7906 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7907 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007908 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7909 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7910 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007911
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007912 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7913 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7914 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7915 front of an existing proxy.
7916
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007917 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7918
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007919 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007920
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007921option httpchk
7922option httpchk <uri>
7923option httpchk <method> <uri>
7924option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007925 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 yes | no | yes | yes
7928 Arguments :
7929 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7930 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7931 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7932 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7933 ones.
7934
7935 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7936 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7937 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7938
7939 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7940 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7941 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007942 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007943
7944 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7945 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7946 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7947 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7948 the lack of any response.
7949
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007950 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7951 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7952 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7953 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7954
7955 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7956 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7957 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007958
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007959 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7960 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007961 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007962 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007963 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007964
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007965 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7966 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7967 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7968 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7969
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007970 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007971 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7972 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7973 backend https_relay
7974 mode tcp
7975 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7976 http-check send hdr Host www
7977 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007978
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007979 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7980 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7981 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007982
7983
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007984option httpclose
7985no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007986 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 yes | yes | yes | yes
7989 Arguments : none
7990
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007991 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7992 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7993 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7994 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007995 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007996
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007997 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7998 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007999 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008000 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8001 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008002
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008003 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8004 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8005 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008006
8007 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8008 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008009 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8010 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8011 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008012
8013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8015
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008016 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008017
8018
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008019option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008020 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008022 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008023 Arguments :
8024 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8025 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8026 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008027 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008028 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008029
8030 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8031 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8032 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8033 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8034 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8035 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8036 ports.
8037
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008038 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8039 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008040
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008041 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008043 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008044
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008045
8046option http_proxy
8047no option http_proxy
8048 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | yes | yes | yes
8051 Arguments : none
8052
8053 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8054 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8055 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8056 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8057 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8058
8059 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8060 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008061 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8062 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008063
8064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8066
8067 Example :
8068 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8069 backend direct_forward
8070 option httpclose
8071 option http_proxy
8072
8073 See also : "option httpclose"
8074
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008075
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008076option independent-streams
8077no option independent-streams
8078 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 yes | yes | yes | yes
8081 Arguments : none
8082
8083 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8084 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8085 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8086 receive data or not.
8087
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008088 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008089 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8090 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8091 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8092 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8093 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8094 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8095 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8096 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8097 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8098 socket buffers.
8099
8100 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8101 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8102 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8103 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8104 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8105
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008106 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008107
8108
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008109option ldap-check
8110 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | no | yes | yes
8113 Arguments : none
8114
8115 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8116 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8117 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8118 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8119
8120 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8121 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8122
8123 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8124 configure it.
8125
8126 Example :
8127 option ldap-check
8128
8129 See also : "option httpchk"
8130
8131
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008132option external-check
8133 Use external processes for server health checks
8134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8135 yes | no | yes | yes
8136
8137 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8138 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8139 command".
8140
8141 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8142
8143 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8144
8145
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008146option log-health-checks
8147no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008148 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | no | yes | yes
8151 Arguments : none
8152
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008153 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8154 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8155 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008156
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008157 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8158 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8159 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8160 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8161 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8162
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008163 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008164 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008165
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008166 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8167 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8168 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008169
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008170
8171option log-separate-errors
8172no option log-separate-errors
8173 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | yes | yes | no
8176 Arguments : none
8177
8178 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8179 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8180 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8181 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8182 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8183 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8184 provides very important information.
8185
8186 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8187 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8188 error logs.
8189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008190 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008191 logging.
8192
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008193
8194option logasap
8195no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008196 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 yes | yes | yes | no
8199 Arguments : none
8200
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008201 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8202 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8203 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8204 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8205
8206 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8207 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8208 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8209 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8210 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008211 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008212 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8213 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8214 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8215 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008216 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008217
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008218 Examples :
8219 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8220 mode http
8221 option httplog
8222 option logasap
8223 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8224
8225 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8226 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8227 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8228 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008230 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008231 logging.
8232
8233
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008234option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008235 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008238 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008239 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8240 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008241 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8242 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008243
8244 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8245 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008246 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008247 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8248 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8249 in the MySQL table, like this :
8250
8251 USE mysql;
8252 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8253 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8254
8255 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008256 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008257 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8258 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8259 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8260 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8261 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8262 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8263 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8264
8265 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8266 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008267
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008268 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008269
8270 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8271 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8272 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8273 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008274 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8275 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008276
8277 See also: "option httpchk"
8278
8279
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008280option nolinger
8281no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008282 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008285 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008288 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8289 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8290 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8291 connections.
8292
8293 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8294 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8295 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8296 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8297 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8298 this too.
8299
8300 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8301 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8302 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8303
8304 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8305 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8306 for servers.
8307
8308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8310
8311
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008312option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8313 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 yes | yes | yes | yes
8316 Arguments :
8317 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8318 matching <network>
8319 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8320 header name.
8321
8322 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8323 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8324 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8325 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8326 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8327 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8328 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8329 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8330 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8331 possible that the client has already brought one.
8332
8333 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8334 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8335 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8336 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8337 header and requires different one.
8338
8339 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8340 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8341 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8342 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8343 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8344 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8345 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8346
8347 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8348 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8349 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8350 both are defined.
8351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008352 Examples :
8353 # Original Destination address
8354 frontend www
8355 mode http
8356 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8357
8358 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8359 backend www
8360 mode http
8361 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8362
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008363 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008364
8365
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008366option persist
8367no option persist
8368 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008372
8373 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8374 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8375 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8376 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8377 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8378 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8379 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8380 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8381 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8382 redirected to another valid server.
8383
8384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8386
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008387 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008388
8389
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008390option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8391 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8393 yes | no | yes | yes
8394 Arguments :
8395 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8396 PostgreSQL server.
8397
8398 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8399 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8400 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8401 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8402
8403 See also: "option httpchk"
8404
8405
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008406option prefer-last-server
8407no option prefer-last-server
8408 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8410 yes | no | yes | yes
8411 Arguments : none
8412
8413 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8414 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8415 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8416 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8417 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8418 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8419 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8420 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8421 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008422 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8423 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008424 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8425 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8426 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008427 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8428 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8429 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008430
8431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8433
8434 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8435
8436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008437option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008438option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008439no option redispatch
8440 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008443 Arguments :
8444 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8445 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8446 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008447 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008448 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008449 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008450 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8451 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8452 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008454
8455 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8456 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8457 be able to access the service anymore.
8458
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008459 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8460 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008461
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008462 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8463 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8464 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8465 following order:
8466
8467 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8468
8469 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8470 list, or
8471
8472 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8473
8474 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8475 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8476
8477 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8478 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8479 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8480 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8481
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008482 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008483 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8484 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8488
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008489 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008490
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008491
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008492option redis-check
8493 Use redis health checks for server testing
8494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 yes | no | yes | yes
8496 Arguments : none
8497
8498 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8499 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8500 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8501 find the "+PONG" response message.
8502
8503 Example :
8504 option redis-check
8505
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008506 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008507
8508
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008509option smtpchk
8510option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8511 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8513 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008515 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008516 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008517 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8518
8519 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8520 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8521 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8522
8523 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8524 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8525 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8526 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8527 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8528 dead server.
8529
8530 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8531 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008533 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8534
8535 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8536 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8537 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8538 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008539 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008540
8541 Example :
8542 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8543
8544 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008547option socket-stats
8548no option socket-stats
8549
8550 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | yes | yes | no
8553
8554 Arguments : none
8555
8556
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008557option splice-auto
8558no option splice-auto
8559 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 yes | yes | yes | yes
8562 Arguments : none
8563
8564 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8565 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008566 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008567 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008568 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008569 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8570 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8571 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8572 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8573
8574 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8575 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8576 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8577 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8578 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8579 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8580 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8581 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8582 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8583 keyword.
8584
8585 Example :
8586 option splice-auto
8587
8588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8590
8591 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8592 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8593
8594
8595option splice-request
8596no option splice-request
8597 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8599 yes | yes | yes | yes
8600 Arguments : none
8601
8602 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008603 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008604 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8605 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8606 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8607 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8608
8609 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8610
8611 Example :
8612 option splice-request
8613
8614 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8615 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8616
8617 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8618 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8619
8620
8621option splice-response
8622no option splice-response
8623 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 yes | yes | yes | yes
8626 Arguments : none
8627
8628 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008629 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008630 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8631 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8632 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8633 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8634
8635 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8636
8637 Example :
8638 option splice-response
8639
8640 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8641 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8642
8643 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8644 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8645
8646
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008647option spop-check
8648 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8650 no | no | no | yes
8651 Arguments : none
8652
8653 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8654 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8655 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8656 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8657
8658 Example :
8659 option spop-check
8660
8661 See also : "option httpchk"
8662
8663
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008664option srvtcpka
8665no option srvtcpka
8666 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | no | yes | yes
8669 Arguments : none
8670
8671 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8672 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008673 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008674 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8675
8676 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8677 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8678 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8679 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8680
8681 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8682 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8683 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8684 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8685 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8686
8687 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8688
8689 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8690 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8691 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8692
8693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8695
8696 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8697
8698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008699option ssl-hello-chk
8700 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8702 yes | no | yes | yes
8703 Arguments : none
8704
8705 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8706 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8707 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8708 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8709 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8710 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8711 hello message.
8712
8713 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8714 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8715 messages, which is appreciable.
8716
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008717 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8718 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8719 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008720
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008721 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8722
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008723
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008724option tcp-check
8725 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8727 yes | no | yes | yes
8728
8729 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8730 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8731
8732 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8733 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8734 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8735
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008736 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008737 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8738 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8739 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8740 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8741 only.
8742
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008743 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008744 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8745 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8746 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8747 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8748
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008749 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008750 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8751 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008752 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008753 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8754 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8755 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8756 the respective protocols.
8757 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008760 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008761
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008762 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8763 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8764 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8765 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008766
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008767 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8768 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8769 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008770
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008771
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008772 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008774 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008775 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008778 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008779 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008780
8781 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8782 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008783 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008784 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008785 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008786 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008787 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008788 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008789 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8790 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008791 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008792 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8793 tcp-check expect string +OK
8794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008795 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008796 (send many headers before analyzing)
8797 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008798 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008799 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8800 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8801 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8802 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008803 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008804
8805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008806 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008807
8808
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008809option tcp-smart-accept
8810no option tcp-smart-accept
8811 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | yes | yes | no
8814 Arguments : none
8815
8816 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8817 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8818 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8819 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8820 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8821 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8822
8823 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8824 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8825 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8826 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8827
8828 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8829 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8830 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008832
8833 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8834 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8835 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8836
8837 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8838 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8839 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8840
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008841 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8842
8843
8844option tcp-smart-connect
8845no option tcp-smart-connect
8846 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 yes | no | yes | yes
8849 Arguments : none
8850
8851 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8852 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8853 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8854 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8855 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8856
8857 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8858 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8859 complex.
8860
8861 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8862 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8863 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8864
8865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8867
8868 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8869
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008870
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008871option tcpka
8872 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8874 yes | yes | yes | yes
8875 Arguments : none
8876
8877 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8878 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008880 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8881
8882 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8883 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8884 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8885 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8886
8887 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8888 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8889 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8890 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8891 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8892
8893 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8894
8895 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8896 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8897 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8898 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8899 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8900 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8901 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8902 backends.
8903
8904 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8905
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008906
8907option tcplog
8908 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008910 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008911 Arguments : none
8912
8913 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8914 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8915 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8916 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8917 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8918 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8919 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8920 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8921
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008922 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008924 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008925
8926
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008927option transparent
8928no option transparent
8929 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008931 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008932 Arguments : none
8933
8934 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8935 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8936 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8937 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8938 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8939 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8940 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8941 appropriate server.
8942
8943 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8944 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8945
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008946 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008947 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008948
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008949
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008950external-check command <command>
8951 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | no | yes | yes
8954
8955 Arguments :
8956 <command> is the external command to run
8957
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008958 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8959
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008960 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008961
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008962 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8963 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8964 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8965 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8966 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8967 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008968
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008969 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8970
8971 Environment variables :
8972 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8973 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8974
8975 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8976
8977 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8978
8979 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8980 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8981 for a UNIX socket).
8982
8983 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8984
8985 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8986
8987 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8988
8989 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8990
8991 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8992
8993 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8994 socket).
8995
8996 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8997 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8998
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008999 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9000
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009001 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9002 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9003 failed.
9004
9005 Example :
9006 external-check command /bin/true
9007
9008 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9009
9010
9011external-check path <path>
9012 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9014 yes | no | yes | yes
9015
9016 Arguments :
9017 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9018
9019 The default path is "".
9020
9021 Example :
9022 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9023
9024 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9025 "external-check command"
9026
9027
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009028persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009029persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009030 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 yes | no | yes | yes
9033 Arguments :
9034 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009035 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9036 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009037
9038 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9039 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009040 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009041 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9042 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9043 forwarded to this server.
9044
9045 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9046 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9047 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009048 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009049 a single "listen" section.
9050
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009051 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9052 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9053 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9054
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009055 Example :
9056 listen tse-farm
9057 bind :3389
9058 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9059 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9060 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9061 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9062 persist rdp-cookie
9063 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009064 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009065 balance rdp-cookie
9066 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9067 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9068
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009069 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9070 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009071
9072
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009073rate-limit sessions <rate>
9074 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9076 yes | yes | yes | no
9077 Arguments :
9078 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9079 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9080
9081 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9082 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9083 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9084 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9085 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9086 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9087
9088 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9089 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9090 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9091 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9092
9093 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9094 listen smtp
9095 mode tcp
9096 bind :25
9097 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009098 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009099
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009100 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9101 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9102 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009103
9104 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9105
9106
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009107redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9108redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9109redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009110 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9112 no | yes | yes | yes
9113
9114 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009115 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009116
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009117 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009118 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009119 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9120 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9121 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009122
9123 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9124 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9125 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9126 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9127 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009128 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9129 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9130 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9131 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009132
9133 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9134 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9135 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9136 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9137 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9138 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009139 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009140 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009141 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9142 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9143 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009144
9145 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009146 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9147 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9148 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009149 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009150 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9151 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9152 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9153 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009154
9155 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009157
9158 - "drop-query"
9159 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9160 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9161 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9162 with a location-type redirect.
9163
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009164 - "append-slash"
9165 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9166 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9167 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9168 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9169
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009170 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9171 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9172 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9173 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9174 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9175 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9176 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9177
9178 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9179 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9180 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9181 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9182 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9183 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9184 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009185
9186 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9187 acl clear dst_port 80
9188 acl secure dst_port 8080
9189 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009190 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009191 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009192 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9193
9194 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009195 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9196 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9197 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009198 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009199
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009200 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9201 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9202 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9203
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009204 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009205 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009206
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009207 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009208 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9209 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9210 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009212 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009213
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009214
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009215retries <value>
9216 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | no | yes | yes
9219 Arguments :
9220 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9221 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9222 default value is 3.
9223
9224 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9225 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9226 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9227
9228 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009229 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9230 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009231
9232 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9233 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9234
9235 See also : "option redispatch"
9236
9237
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009238retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009239 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9240 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9241 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9243 yes | no | yes | yes
9244 Arguments :
9245 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9246 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9247 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9248 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9249
9250 none never retry
9251
9252 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9253 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9254
9255 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9256 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9257 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9258 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9259 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9260 processing the request.
9261
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009262 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9263 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9264 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9265 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9266 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9267 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9268 overflow attack for example).
9269
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009270 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9271 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9272 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9273 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9274 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9275 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9276 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9277 amplify denial of service attacks.
9278
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009279 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9280 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9281 considered to be safe to retry.
9282
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009283 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9284 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9285 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9286 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9287
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009288 all-retryable-errors
9289 retry request for any error that are considered
9290 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9291 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9292 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9293
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009294 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9295 not cumulative.
9296
9297 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9298 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9299 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9300 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9301
9302 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9303 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9304 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9305 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9306 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9307 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9308 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9309 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9310 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9311 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9312 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9313 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9314
9315 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9316 should not use this directive.
9317
9318 The default is "conn-failure".
9319
9320 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9321
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009322server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009323 Declare a server in a backend
9324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9325 no | no | yes | yes
9326 Arguments :
9327 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009328 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009329 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009330
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009331 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9332 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9333 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9334 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009335 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9336 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9337 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9338 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9339 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009340 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9341 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9342 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9343 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9344 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9345 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9346 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009347 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009348 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9349 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9350 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9351 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9352 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9353 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009354 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9355 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009356 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9357 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009359 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009360 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9361 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9362 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9363 adding this value to the client's port.
9364
9365 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9366 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009367 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009368
9369 Examples :
9370 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9371 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009372 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009373 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9374 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9375 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009376
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009377 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9378 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9379 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9380 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9381 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9382
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009383 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9384 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009385
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009386server-state-file-name [<file>]
9387 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9388 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9389 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9390 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9391 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9392 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9393
9394 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9395 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9396
9397 global
9398 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9399
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009400 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009401 load-server-state-from-file
9402
9403 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9404 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009405
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009406server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9407 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9408 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9410 no | no | yes | yes
9411
9412 Arguments:
9413 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9414
9415 <num | range>
9416 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9417 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9418 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9419 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9420
9421 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9422
9423 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9424
9425 <params*>
9426 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9427 keyword.
9428
9429 Examples:
9430 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9431 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9432 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9433
9434 # or
9435 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9436
9437 # would be equivalent to:
9438 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9439 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9440 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9441
9442
9443
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009444source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009445source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009446source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009447 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9449 yes | no | yes | yes
9450 Arguments :
9451 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9452 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009453
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009454 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009455 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9456 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9457 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9458 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9459 supported prefixes are :
9460 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9461 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9462 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009463 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009464 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9465 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009466
9467 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9468 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009469 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9470 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9471 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009472
9473 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9474 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9475 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9476 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9477 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9478 <addr>.
9479
9480 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9481 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9482 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9483 port.
9484
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009485 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9486 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9487 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9488 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009489 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009490 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9491 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9492 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9493 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9494 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9495 HTTP header.
9496
9497 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9498 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009499 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009500 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9501 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9502 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9503 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9504 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9505 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9506 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9507
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009508 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9509 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9510 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9511 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9512 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9513 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9514
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009515 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9516 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9517 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9518 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9519
9520 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9521 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9522 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9523 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9524 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9525 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9526
9527 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9528 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9529 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9530 there are two methods :
9531
9532 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9533 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9534 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9535 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9536 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9537 of the client ranges may be used.
9538
9539 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9540 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9541 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9542 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9543 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9544 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9545 same session.
9546
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009547 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9548 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9549 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009550 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009551
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009552 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009554 Examples :
9555 backend private
9556 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9557 source 192.168.1.200
9558
9559 backend transparent_ssl1
9560 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9561 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9562
9563 backend transparent_ssl2
9564 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9565 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9566 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9567
9568 backend transparent_ssl3
9569 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9570 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9571 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9572
9573 backend transparent_smtp
9574 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9575 # with Tproxy version 4.
9576 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9577
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009578 backend transparent_http
9579 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9580 # proxy.
9581 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009584 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9585
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009586
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009587srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9588 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9589 the connection on the server side.
9590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9591 yes | no | yes | yes
9592 Arguments :
9593 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9594
9595 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9596 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009597 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9598 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009599
9600 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9601
9602
9603srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9604 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9605 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9606 server side.
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9608 yes | no | yes | yes
9609 Arguments :
9610 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9611 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9612 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9613 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9614
9615 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9616 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009617 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9618 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009619
9620 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9621
9622
9623srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9624 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9626 yes | no | yes | yes
9627 Arguments :
9628 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9629 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9630 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9631 document.
9632
9633 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9634 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009635 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9636 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009637
9638 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9639
9640
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009641stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9642 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009644 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009645
9646 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9647 matched.
9648
9649 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9650 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009652 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9653 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009654 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009655
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009656 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9657 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9658 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9659 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009660
9661 Example :
9662 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9663 backend stats_localhost
9664 stats enable
9665 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9666
9667 Example :
9668 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9669 backend stats_auth
9670 stats enable
9671 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9672 stats admin if TRUE
9673
9674 Example :
9675 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9676 userlist stats-auth
9677 group admin users admin
9678 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9679 group readonly users haproxy
9680 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9681
9682 backend stats_auth
9683 stats enable
9684 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9685 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9686 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9687 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9688
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009689 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9690 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9691 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009692
9693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009694stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9695 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009697 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009698 Arguments :
9699 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9700
9701 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9702
9703 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9704 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9705 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9706 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9707 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9708 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9709
9710 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9711 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9712 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009713 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009714
9715 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9716 report using "stats scope".
9717
9718 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9719 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9720 unobvious parameters.
9721
9722 Example :
9723 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9724 backend public_www
9725 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9726 stats enable
9727 stats hide-version
9728 stats scope .
9729 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009730 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009731 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9732 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9733
9734 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9735 backend private_monitoring
9736 stats enable
9737 stats uri /admin?stats
9738 stats refresh 5s
9739
9740 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9741
9742
9743stats enable
9744 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009746 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009747 Arguments : none
9748
9749 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9750 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9751 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9752 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9753 - stats auth : no authentication
9754 - stats scope : no restriction
9755
9756 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9757 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9758 unobvious parameters.
9759
9760 Example :
9761 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9762 backend public_www
9763 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9764 stats enable
9765 stats hide-version
9766 stats scope .
9767 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009769 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9770 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9771
9772 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9773 backend private_monitoring
9774 stats enable
9775 stats uri /admin?stats
9776 stats refresh 5s
9777
9778 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9779
9780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009781stats hide-version
9782 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009784 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009785 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009787 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9788 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9789 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9790 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9791 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9792 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009794 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9795 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9796 unobvious parameters.
9797
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009798 Example :
9799 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9800 backend public_www
9801 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009802 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009803 stats hide-version
9804 stats scope .
9805 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009807 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9808 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009809
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009810 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9811 backend private_monitoring
9812 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009813 stats uri /admin?stats
9814 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009816 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009817
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009818
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009819stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9821 Access control for statistics
9822
9823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 no | no | yes | yes
9825
9826 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9827 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9828 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9829 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9830 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9831 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9832
9833 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9834 instance.
9835
9836 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9837 about ACL usage.
9838
9839
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009840stats realm <realm>
9841 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009843 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009844 Arguments :
9845 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9846 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9847 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9848
9849 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9850 using a backslash ('\').
9851
9852 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9853 only related to authentication.
9854
9855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9857 unobvious parameters.
9858
9859 Example :
9860 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9861 backend public_www
9862 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9863 stats enable
9864 stats hide-version
9865 stats scope .
9866 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009867 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009868 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9869 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9870
9871 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9872 backend private_monitoring
9873 stats enable
9874 stats uri /admin?stats
9875 stats refresh 5s
9876
9877 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9878
9879
9880stats refresh <delay>
9881 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009884 Arguments :
9885 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9886 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9887 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9888 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9889 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9890 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9891
9892 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9893 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9894 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009895 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009896
9897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9899 unobvious parameters.
9900
9901 Example :
9902 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9903 backend public_www
9904 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9905 stats enable
9906 stats hide-version
9907 stats scope .
9908 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009909 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009910 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9911 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9912
9913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9914 backend private_monitoring
9915 stats enable
9916 stats uri /admin?stats
9917 stats refresh 5s
9918
9919 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9920
9921
9922stats scope { <name> | "." }
9923 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009925 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009926 Arguments :
9927 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9928 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9929 section in which the statement appears.
9930
9931 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9932 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9933 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9934 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9935 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9936 exists.
9937
9938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9940 unobvious parameters.
9941
9942 Example :
9943 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9944 backend public_www
9945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9946 stats enable
9947 stats hide-version
9948 stats scope .
9949 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009950 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009951 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9952 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9953
9954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9955 backend private_monitoring
9956 stats enable
9957 stats uri /admin?stats
9958 stats refresh 5s
9959
9960 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9961
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009962
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009963stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009964 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009966 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009967
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009968 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009969 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9970
9971 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9972 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9973
9974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009976 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009977
9978 Example :
9979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9980 backend private_monitoring
9981 stats enable
9982 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9983 stats uri /admin?stats
9984 stats refresh 5s
9985
9986 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9987 global section.
9988
9989
9990stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009991 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9993 yes | yes | yes | yes
9994 Arguments : none
9995
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009996 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009997 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9998 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9999 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10000 - IP (socket, server)
10001 - cookie (backend, server)
10002
10003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010005 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010006
10007 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10008
10009
10010stats show-node [ <name> ]
10011 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010013 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010014 Arguments:
10015 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10016 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10017
10018 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10019 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010020 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010021
10022 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10023 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10024 unobvious parameters.
10025
10026 Example:
10027 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10028 backend private_monitoring
10029 stats enable
10030 stats show-node Europe-1
10031 stats uri /admin?stats
10032 stats refresh 5s
10033
10034 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10035 section.
10036
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010037
10038stats uri <prefix>
10039 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010041 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010042 Arguments :
10043 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10044 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10045 query string.
10046
10047 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10048 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10049 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10050 possible to reach it in the application.
10051
10052 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010053 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010054 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10055 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10056 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10057 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10058
10059 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10060 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10061 an address or a port to statistics only.
10062
10063 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10064 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10065 unobvious parameters.
10066
10067 Example :
10068 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10069 backend public_www
10070 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10071 stats enable
10072 stats hide-version
10073 stats scope .
10074 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010075 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010076 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10077 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10078
10079 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10080 backend private_monitoring
10081 stats enable
10082 stats uri /admin?stats
10083 stats refresh 5s
10084
10085 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10086
10087
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010088stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10089 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010091 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010092
10093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010094 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010095 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010096 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010097 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10098
10099 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10100 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10101 the "stick-table" statement.
10102
10103 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10104 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10105 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10106 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10107 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10108
10109 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10110 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10111 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10112 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10113 transformation rules.
10114
10115 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10116 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10117 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10118 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10119 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10120 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10121 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10122
10123 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10124 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10125 ACL based conditions.
10126
10127 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10128 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10129 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10130 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10131
10132 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10133 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10134 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10135 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10136
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010137 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10138 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010139 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010140
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010141 Example :
10142 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10143 # last 30 minutes
10144 backend pop
10145 mode tcp
10146 balance roundrobin
10147 stick store-request src
10148 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10149 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10150 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10151
10152 backend smtp
10153 mode tcp
10154 balance roundrobin
10155 stick match src table pop
10156 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10157 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10158
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010159 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010160 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010161
10162
10163stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10164 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10166 no | no | yes | yes
10167
10168 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10169 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10170 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10171 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10172
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010173 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10174 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010175 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010176
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010177 Examples :
10178 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010179 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010180
10181 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10182 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10183 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10184
10185
10186 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10187 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10188 backend http
10189 mode http
10190 balance roundrobin
10191 stick on src table https
10192 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10193 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10194 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10195
10196 backend https
10197 mode tcp
10198 balance roundrobin
10199 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10200 stick on src
10201 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10202 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10203
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010204 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010205
10206
10207stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10208 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10210 no | no | yes | yes
10211
10212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010213 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010214 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010215 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010216 server is selected.
10217
10218 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10219 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10220 the "stick-table" statement.
10221
10222 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10223 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10224 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10225 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10226 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10227 address.
10228
10229 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10230 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10231 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10232 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10233 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10234 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10235 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10236 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10237 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10238 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10239
10240 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10241 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10242 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10243 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10244 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10245 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10246 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10247
10248 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10249 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10250 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10251 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10252
10253 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10254 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10255 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10256 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10257 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10258 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010259 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10260 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10261 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10262 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10263 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10264 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010265
10266 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10267 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10268 the request.
10269
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010270 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10271 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010272 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010273
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010274 Example :
10275 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10276 # last 30 minutes
10277 backend pop
10278 mode tcp
10279 balance roundrobin
10280 stick store-request src
10281 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10282 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10283 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10284
10285 backend smtp
10286 mode tcp
10287 balance roundrobin
10288 stick match src table pop
10289 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10290 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10291
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010292 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010293 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010294
10295
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010296stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010297 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10298 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010299 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010301 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010302
10303 Arguments :
10304 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10305 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10306 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10307 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10308
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010309 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10310 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10311 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10312 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10313
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010314 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10315 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10316 instance.
10317
10318 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10319 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10320 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10321 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10322 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10323 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010324 to 32 characters.
10325
10326 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10327 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10328 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010329 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010330 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10331 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010332
10333 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010334 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10335 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010336 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10337 increase.
10338
10339 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010340 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10341 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10342 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010343
10344 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10345 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10346 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10347 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010348 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010349 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10350 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10351 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10352 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10353 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10354 parameter (see below).
10355
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010356 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10357 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10358 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10359 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10360 soft restart.
10361
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010362 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10363 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010364
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010365 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10366 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10367 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10368 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010369 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010370 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010371 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10372 if not expiration delay is specified.
10373
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010374 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10375 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10376 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10377 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010378 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10379 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10380 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10381 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10382 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10383 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10384 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10385 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10386 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10387 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10388 types and their arguments.
10389
10390 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10391 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10392 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10393 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10394
10395 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10396 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10397 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010398 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010399
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010400 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10401 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10402 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010403 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010404 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010405 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010406
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010407 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10408 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10409 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10410 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10411
10412 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10413 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10414 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10415 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10416 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10417 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10418
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010419 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10420 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10421 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10422 they were received.
10423
10424 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10425 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10426 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10427 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10428 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10429
10430 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10431 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10432 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10433 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10434 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10435
10436 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10437 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10438 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10439
10440 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10441 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10442 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10443 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10444 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10445
10446 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10447 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10448 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10449 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10450 the client side.
10451
10452 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10453 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10454 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10455 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10456 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10457 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10458 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10459
10460 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10461 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10462 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10463 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10464 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10465 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010466 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010467
10468 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10469 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10470 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10471 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10472 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10473 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10474
10475 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010476 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010477 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10478 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10479
10480 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10481 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10482 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10483 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10484 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10485 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10486 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10487 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10488 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10489 recommended for better fairness.
10490
10491 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010492 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010493 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10494 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10495
10496 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10497 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10498 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10499 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10500 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10501 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10502 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10503 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10504 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10505 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010506
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010507 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10508 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010509 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10510 reference it.
10511
10512 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10513 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010514 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10515 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10516 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010517
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010518 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10519 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10520 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10521 something that can be ignored.
10522
10523 Example:
10524 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10525 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10526 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10527 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10528
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010529 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010530 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010531
10532
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010533stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010534 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10536 no | no | yes | yes
10537
10538 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010539 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010540 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010542 server is selected.
10543
10544 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10545 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10546 the "stick-table" statement.
10547
10548 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10549 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10550 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10551 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10552
10553 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10554 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10555 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10556 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10557 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10558 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010559 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010560 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10561 rules.
10562
10563 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10564 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10565 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10566 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10567 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10568 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10569 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10570
10571 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10572 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10573 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10574 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10575
10576 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10577 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10578 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10579 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10580 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10581 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010582 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10583 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10584 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10585 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10586 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10587 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10588 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10589 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10590 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010591
10592 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10593
10594 Example :
10595 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10596 backend https
10597 mode tcp
10598 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010599 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010600 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010601
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010602 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10603 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10604
10605 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10606 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10607 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10608
10609 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10610 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010611
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010612 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10613 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10614 # at offset 44.
10615
10616 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10617 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10618
10619 # Learn on response if server hello.
10620 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010621
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010622 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10623 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10624
10625 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10626 extraction.
10627
10628
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010629tcp-check comment <string>
10630 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10631 it fails.
10632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10633 yes | no | yes | yes
10634
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010635 Arguments :
10636 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10637 rule fails.
10638
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010639 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10640 user-friendly error reporting.
10641
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010642 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10643 "tcp-check expect".
10644
10645
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010646tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10647 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010648 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010649 Opens a new connection
10650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010651 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010652
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010653 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010654 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10655
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010656 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010657 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010658
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010659 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010660 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10661 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010662 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010663
10664 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010665
10666 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10667
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010668 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10669
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010670 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10671
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010672 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10673
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010674 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10675 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10676 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10677 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10678
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010679 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10680 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10681 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10682 haproxy -vv.
10683
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010684 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010685
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010686 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10687 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10688 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10689
10690 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10691 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10692 of the sequence.
10693
10694 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10695 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10696 do.
10697
10698 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10699 unset-var or comment rules.
10700
10701 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010702 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10703 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10704 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10705 option tcp-check
10706 tcp-check connect
10707 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10708 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10709 tcp-check send \r\n
10710 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10711 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10712 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10713 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10714 tcp-check send \r\n
10715 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10716 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10717
10718 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10719 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010720 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010721 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10722 tcp-check connect port 143
10723 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10724 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10725
10726 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10727
10728
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010729tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010730 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010731 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010732 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010733 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010735 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010736
10737 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010738 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10739
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010740 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10741 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10742 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10743 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10744 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10745 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10746 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10747 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10748 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10749 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10750
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010751 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010752 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10753 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010754 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10755 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10756 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10757
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010758 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10759 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10760 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010761 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10762 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10763 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10764 example 404 with disable-on-404
10765 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10766 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010767 By default "L7OK" is used.
10768
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010769 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10770 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010771 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10772 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10773 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10774 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10775 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10776 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010777
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010778 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010779 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010780 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10781 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10782 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10783 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010784 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10785
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010786 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10787 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10788 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10789 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10790
10791 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10792 informational message reported in logs if an error
10793 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10794 log-format string.
10795
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010796 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10797 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10798 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10799 followed by some converters.
10800
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010801 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10802 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10803 with the usual backslash ('\').
10804 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010805 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010806 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10807 used upper or lower case.
10808
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010809 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10810
10811 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10812 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10813 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10814 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10815 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10816 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10817 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10818 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10819
10820 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10821 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10822 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10823 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10824 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10825 expression.
10826
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010827 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10828 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10829 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10830 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10831 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10832 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10833
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010834 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10835 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10836 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10837 this exact hexadecimal string.
10838 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10839
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010840 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10841 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10842 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10843 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10844 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10845 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10846 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10847 size.
10848
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010849 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10850 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10851 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10852 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10853 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10854 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10855 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10856 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10857 in a binary string before matching the response's
10858 buffer.
10859
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010860 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10861 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10862 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10863 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10864 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10865 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10866 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10867 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10868 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10869 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10870 the null character.
10871
10872 Examples :
10873 # perform a POP check
10874 option tcp-check
10875 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10876
10877 # perform an IMAP check
10878 option tcp-check
10879 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10880
10881 # look for the redis master server
10882 option tcp-check
10883 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010884 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010885 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10886 tcp-check expect string role:master
10887 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10888 tcp-check expect string +OK
10889
10890
10891 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10892 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10893
10894
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010895tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10896tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10897 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10898 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010900 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010901
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010902 Arguments :
10903 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10904
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010905 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10906 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010907
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010908 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10909 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010910
10911 Examples :
10912 # look for the redis master server
10913 option tcp-check
10914 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10915 tcp-check expect string role:master
10916
10917 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10918 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10919
10920
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010921tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10922tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10923 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10924 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010926 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010927
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010928 Arguments :
10929 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010930
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010931 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10932 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010933
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010934 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10935 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10936 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010937
10938 Examples :
10939 # redis check in binary
10940 option tcp-check
10941 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10942 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10943
10944
10945 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10946 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10947
10948
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010949tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010950 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010952 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010953
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010954 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010955 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10956 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10957 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10958 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10959 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10961 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10962 and '-'.
10963
10964 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010966 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010967 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10968
10969
10970tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010971 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010973 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010974
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010975 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010976 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10977 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10980 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10982 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10983 and '-'.
10984
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010985 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010986 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10987
10988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010989tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10990 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010993 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010994 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10995 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010997 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010998
10999 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11000 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011001 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11002 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11003 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11004 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11005 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11006 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011008 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11009 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11010 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11011 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011012
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011013 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011014 - accept :
11015 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11016 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11017 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011019 - reject :
11020 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11021 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11022 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11023 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11024 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11025 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11026 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11027 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11028 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11029 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11030 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011031 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011032
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011033 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11034 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11035 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11036 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11037 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11038 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11039 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11040 hosts.
11041
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011042 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11043 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11044 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11045 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11046 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11047 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11048 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11049 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11050
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011051 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11052 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11053 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11054 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11055 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11056 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11057 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11058 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11059 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011060 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11061 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011062
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011063 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011064 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011065 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11066 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11067 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011068 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011069 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11070 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11071 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11072 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11073 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11074 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11075 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11076 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011078 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011079 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011081 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011082 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11083 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11084 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011086 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11087 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11088 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11089 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011091 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11092 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11093 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11094 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11095 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011096 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11097 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11098 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11099 layer7 information is extracted.
11100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011101 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11102 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11103 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11104 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11105 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011106
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011107 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11108 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11109 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11110 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11111
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011112 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11113 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11114 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11115 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11116
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011117 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11118 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11119 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11120 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11121 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011122
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011123 - set-src <expr> :
11124 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11125 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11126 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011127 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011129 Arguments:
11130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11131 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011132
11133 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011134 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11135
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011136 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11137 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011138
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011139 - set-src-port <expr> :
11140 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11141 expression.
11142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011143 Arguments:
11144 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11145 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011146
11147 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011148 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11149
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011150 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11151 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11152 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011153
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011154 - set-dst <expr> :
11155 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11156 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11157 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11158 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11159 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11160
11161 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11162 followed by some converters.
11163
11164 Example:
11165
11166 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11167 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11168
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011169 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11170 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11171
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011172 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11173 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11174 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11175 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11176
11177
11178 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11179 followed by some converters.
11180
11181 Example:
11182
11183 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11184
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011185 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11186 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11187 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11188
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011189 - "silent-drop" :
11190 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011191 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011192 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11193 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11194 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11195 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11196 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011197 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11198 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011199 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11200 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011202 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11203 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11204 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11205 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011207 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11208 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11209 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011211 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11212 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11213 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011215 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011216 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011217 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011219 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11220 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11221 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011223 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011224 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11225 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011226
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011227 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11228
11229 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11230
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011231 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11232
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011233 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011234
11235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011236tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11237 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011239 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011241 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11242 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011244 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011245
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011246 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011247 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11248 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11249 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11250 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011252 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11253 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11254 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11255 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011256 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11257 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11258 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11259 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11260 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11261 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011262 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011263 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011265 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11266 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11267 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11268 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011269
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011270 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011271 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011272 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011273 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11274 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011275 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011276 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011277 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011278 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011279 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011280 - set-dst <expr>
11281 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011282 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011283 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011284 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011286 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11289 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011290 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11291 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011292
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011293 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11294 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11295 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11296 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11297 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11298 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011300 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011301 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11302 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011304 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011305 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11306 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11307 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11308 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011309 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11310 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11311 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011312
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011313 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011314 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11315 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11316 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011317
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011318 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11319 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11320
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011321 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011322 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11323 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011324
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011325 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11326 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011327 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011328 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11329 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011330 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011331 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011332 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011333 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11334 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011335 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011336 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11337 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011338
11339 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11340 followed by some converters.
11341
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011342 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11343 <var-name>.
11344
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011345 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11346 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11347 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11348 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11349 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11350
11351 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11352 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11353 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11354 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11355 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11356 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11357 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11358 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11359 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11360 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11361 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11362
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011363 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11364 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11365 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11366 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11367 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11368
11369 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11370
11371 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11372
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011373 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11374 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11375 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11376 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11377 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11378 evaluated.
11379
11380 Example:
11381 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11382
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011383 Example:
11384
11385 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011386 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011387
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011388 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011389 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11390 # and reject everything else.
11391 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11392 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011393 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011394 tcp-request content reject
11395
11396 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011397 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11398 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11399 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011400 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011401
11402 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11403 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11404 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011405 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011406 tcp-request content reject
11407
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011408 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011409 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011410 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011411 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011412 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11413 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011414
11415 Example:
11416 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11417 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011418 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011420 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011421 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011422
11423 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011425 # protecting all our sites
11426 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011427 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11428 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011429 ...
11430 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11431
11432 backend http_dynamic
11433 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011434 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011435 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011436 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011437 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011438 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011439 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011441 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011442
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011443 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11444 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011445
11446
11447tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11448 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011450 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011451 Arguments :
11452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11454 as explained at the top of this document.
11455
11456 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11457 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11458 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11459 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11460 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11461
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011462 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11463 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11464 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11465 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11466
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011467 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11468 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011469 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011470 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011471 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11472 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11473 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11474 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011475
11476 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11477 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11478 it pass through unaffected.
11479
11480 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11481 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11482 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011483 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11485 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011486 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11487 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11488 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011489
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011490 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011491 "timeout client".
11492
11493
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011494tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11495 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11497 no | no | yes | yes
11498 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011499 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11500 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011501
11502 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011505 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11506 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011507 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11508 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011509
11510 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11511
11512 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11513 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11514 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11515 inserted.
11516
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011517 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011518 - accept :
11519 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11520 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11521 the rules evaluation.
11522
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011523 - close :
11524 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11525 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11526 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11527 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11528 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11529 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011530 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011531 protocols.
11532
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011533 - reject :
11534 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11535 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011536 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011537
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011538 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11539 Sets a variable.
11540
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011541 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11542 Unsets a variable.
11543
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011544 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11545 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11546 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11547 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11548
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011549 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11550 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11551 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11552 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11553
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011554 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11555 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11556 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11557 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11558 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011559
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011560 - "silent-drop" :
11561 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011562 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011563 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11564 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11565 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11566 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11567 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011568 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11569 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011570 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11571 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011572 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011573 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11574 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11575 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11576 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11577
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011578 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11579 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11580
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011581 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11582 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11583 for changing the default action to a reject.
11584
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011585 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11586 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11587 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11588 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011589 period.
11590
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011591 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11592 declared inline.
11593
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011594 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11595 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011596 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011597 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11598 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011599 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011600 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011601 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011602 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11603 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011605 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11606 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011607
11608 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11609 followed by some converters.
11610
11611 Example:
11612
11613 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11614
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011615 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11616 <var-name>.
11617
11618 Example:
11619
11620 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11621
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011622 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11623 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11624 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11625 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11626 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11627
11628 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11629
11630 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11631
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011632 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11633
11634 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11635
11636
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011637tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11638 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11640 no | yes | yes | no
11641 Arguments :
11642 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11643 below.
11644
11645 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11646
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011647 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011648 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11649 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11650 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11651 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11652 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11653 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11654 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011655 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011656 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11657 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11658 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11659 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11660 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11661 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11662 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11663 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11664 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11665 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11666 instead.
11667
11668 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11669 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11670 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11671 rules which may be inserted.
11672
11673 Several types of actions are supported :
11674 - accept : the request is accepted
11675 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11676 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11677 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011678 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011679 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011680 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011681 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011682 - silent-drop
11683
11684 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11685 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11686 sections for a complete description.
11687
11688 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11689 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11690 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11691
11692 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11693 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11694 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11695 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11696 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11697
11698 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11699 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11700
11701 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11702 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11703 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11704
11705 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11706 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11707 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11708
11709 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11710 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11711 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11712
11713 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11714 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11715 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11716
11717 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11718
11719 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11720
11721
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011722tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11723 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11725 no | no | yes | yes
11726 Arguments :
11727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11729 as explained at the top of this document.
11730
11731 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11732
11733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011734timeout check <timeout>
11735 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11736 established.
11737
11738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11739 yes | no | yes | yes
11740 Arguments:
11741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11743 as explained at the top of this document.
11744
11745 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11746 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011747 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011748 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011749 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11750 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11751 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011752
11753 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11754 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11755
11756 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11757 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011758 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011759
11760 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11761 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11762 forget about it.
11763
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011764 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11765 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011766
11767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011768timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011769 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11771 yes | yes | yes | no
11772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11775 as explained at the top of this document.
11776
11777 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11778 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11779 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011780 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11781 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11782 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11783 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011784 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11785 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11786 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011787 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011788 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011789 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11790 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011791 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11792 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011793
11794 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11795 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11796 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11797 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011798 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011799 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11800
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011801 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011802
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011803 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011805
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011806timeout client-fin <timeout>
11807 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11809 yes | yes | yes | no
11810 Arguments :
11811 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11813 as explained at the top of this document.
11814
11815 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11816 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11817 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11818 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11819 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11820 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11821 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011822 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11823 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11824 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011825
11826 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11827 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11828 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11829
11830 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11831
11832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011833timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011834 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11836 yes | no | yes | yes
11837 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011838 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011839 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11840 as explained at the top of this document.
11841
11842 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011843 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011844 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011845 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011846 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11847 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011848
11849 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11850 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11851 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11852 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011853 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011854 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11855
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011856 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011858
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011859timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11860 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11862 yes | yes | yes | yes
11863 Arguments :
11864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11866 as explained at the top of this document.
11867
11868 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11869 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11870 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11871 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11872 once the request has started to present itself.
11873
11874 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11875 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11876 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11877 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11878 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11879
11880 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11881 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11882 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11883 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11884
11885 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11886 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011887 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011888 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11889 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011890 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011891
11892 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11893 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11894 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11895 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11896
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011897 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11898 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011899 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11900
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011901 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11902
11903
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011904timeout http-request <timeout>
11905 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011907 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011908 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011909 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11911 as explained at the top of this document.
11912
11913 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11914 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11915 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11916 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11917 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11918 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11919 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011920 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11921 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11922 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11923 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011924 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011925 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11926 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011927
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011928 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11929 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11930 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11931 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11932 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011933 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011934
11935 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11936 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011937 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011938 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11939 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11940
11941 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011942 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11943 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11944 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011945
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011946 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011947 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011948
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011949
11950timeout queue <timeout>
11951 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11953 yes | no | yes | yes
11954 Arguments :
11955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11957 as explained at the top of this document.
11958
11959 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11960 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11961 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11962 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11963 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11964
11965 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11966 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11967 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11968 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11969
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011970 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011971
11972
11973timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011974 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11976 yes | no | yes | yes
11977 Arguments :
11978 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11979 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11980 as explained at the top of this document.
11981
11982 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11983 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11984 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11985 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11986 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11987 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11988 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11989
11990 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11991 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11992 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11993 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11994 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011995 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011996 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011997 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11998 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011999 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12000 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012001
12002 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12003 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12004 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12005 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012006 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012007 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12008
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012009 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012010
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012011
12012timeout server-fin <timeout>
12013 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12015 yes | no | yes | yes
12016 Arguments :
12017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12019 as explained at the top of this document.
12020
12021 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12022 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12023 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12024 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12025 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12026 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12027 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12028 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12029 situations, it should not be needed.
12030
12031 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12032 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12033 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12034
12035 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12036
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012037
12038timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012039 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12041 yes | yes | yes | yes
12042 Arguments :
12043 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12045 as explained at the top of this document.
12046
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012047 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12048 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12049 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012050
12051 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12052 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12053 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12054 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012055 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012056
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012057 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012058
12059
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012060timeout tunnel <timeout>
12061 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12063 yes | no | yes | yes
12064 Arguments :
12065 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12067 as explained at the top of this document.
12068
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012069 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012070 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12071 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12072 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12074 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012075 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12076 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12077 specified.
12078
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012079 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12080 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12081 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12082 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12083 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12084 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12085 state.
12086
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012087 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12088 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12089 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12090 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012091 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012092
12093 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12094 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12095 forget about it.
12096
12097 Example :
12098 defaults http
12099 option http-server-close
12100 timeout connect 5s
12101 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012102 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012103 timeout server 30s
12104 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12105
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012106 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012107
12108
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012109transparent (deprecated)
12110 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012113 Arguments : none
12114
12115 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12116 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12117 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12118 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12119 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12120 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12121 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12122 appropriate server.
12123
12124 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12125
12126 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12127 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12128
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012129 See also: "option transparent"
12130
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012131unique-id-format <string>
12132 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12134 yes | yes | yes | no
12135 Arguments :
12136 <string> is a log-format string.
12137
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012138 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12139 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12140 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12141 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012142
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012143 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12144 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12145 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12146 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12147 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12148 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12149 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12150 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012152 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12153 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012154
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012155 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012156
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012157 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012158
12159 will generate:
12160
12161 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12162
12163 See also: "unique-id-header"
12164
12165unique-id-header <name>
12166 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12168 yes | yes | yes | no
12169 Arguments :
12170 <name> is the name of the header.
12171
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012172 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12173 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012174
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012175 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012176
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012177 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012178 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12179
12180 will generate:
12181
12182 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12183
12184 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012185
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012186use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012187 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12189 no | yes | yes | no
12190 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012191 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12192 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012193
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012194 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12195 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012196
12197 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12198 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12199 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012200 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012201 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012202 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12203 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012204
12205 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12206 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12207 assign the backend.
12208
12209 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12210 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12211 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12212 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12213 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12214 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12215
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012216 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012217 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012218 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12219 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12220 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12221
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012222 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12223 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12224 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12225 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12226 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12227 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12228 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12229 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12230 cannot be forced from the request.
12231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012232 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012233 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12234 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12235
12236 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12237 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012238
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012239use-fcgi-app <name>
12240 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12242 no | no | yes | yes
12243 Arguments :
12244 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12245
12246 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012247
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012248use-server <server> if <condition>
12249use-server <server> unless <condition>
12250 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12252 no | no | yes | yes
12253 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012254 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12255 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012256
12257 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12258
12259 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12260 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12261 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12262
12263 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12264 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12265 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12266 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12267 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12268 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12269 matches will assign the server.
12270
12271 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12272 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12273 with the next rules until one matches.
12274
12275 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12276 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12277 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12278 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12279
12280 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12281 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12282 stripped.
12283
12284 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12285 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012286 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12287 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12288 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012289
12290 Example :
12291 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12292 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12293 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12294 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012295 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012296 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012297 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012298 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12299 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12300
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012301 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12302 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12303 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12304 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012305 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012306 and we fall back to load balancing.
12307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012308 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012310
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123115. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012312--------------------------
12313
12314The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12315depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12316settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12317written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12318described in this section.
12319
12320
123215.1. Bind options
12322-----------------
12323
12324The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12325as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12326no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12327parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12328while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12329provided immediately after the setting name.
12330
12331The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12332
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012333accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12334 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12335 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12336 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12337 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12338 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12339 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12340 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12341 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12342 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012343 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12344 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12345 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012346
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012347accept-proxy
12348 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012349 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12350 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012351 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12352 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12353 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12354 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012355 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012356 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12357 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012358 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12359 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012360
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012361allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012362 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012363 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012364 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012365 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12366 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012367
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012368alpn <protocols>
12369 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12370 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12371 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012372 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012373 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012374 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12375 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12376 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12377 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12378 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12379 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12380 preference, like below :
12381
12382 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012383
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012384backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012385 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012386 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12387
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012388curves <curves>
12389 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12390 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12391 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12392 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12393 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12394 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12395
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012396ecdhe <named curve>
12397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012398 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12399 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012400
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012401ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12403 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12404 client's certificate.
12405
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012406ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12407 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12408 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12409 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12410 error is ignored.
12411
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012412ca-sign-file <cafile>
12413 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12414 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12415 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12416 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12417 'generate-certificates' for details.
12418
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012419ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12421 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12422 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12423 'generate-certificates' for details.
12424
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012425ca-verify-file <cafile>
12426 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12427 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12428 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12429 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12430 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012432ciphers <ciphers>
12433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12434 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012435 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012436 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012437 information and recommendations see e.g.
12438 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12439 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12440 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12441
12442ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12444 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12445 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12446 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012447 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12448 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012449
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012450crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12452 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12453 to verify client's certificate.
12454
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012455crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12457 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12458 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12459 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12460 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012461 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12462 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012463
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012464 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12465 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12466
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012467 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12468 are loaded.
12469
12470 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012471 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12472 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12473 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12474 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12475 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12476 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12477 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012478 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012479
12480 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12481 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12482 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12483 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012484 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12485 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012486
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012487 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012489 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012490 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012491 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12492 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012493 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12494 clients).
12495
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012496 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12497 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12498 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12499 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12500 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12501 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12502 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12503 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12504 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12505 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12506 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12507 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12508 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12509
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012510 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12511 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12512 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12513 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12514 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12515
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012516 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12517 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12518 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12519 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012520
William Lallemand98d215e2020-09-16 17:42:37 +020012521 In order to provide this feature, multiple PEM files, each with a different
12522 key type, are required. Since HAProxy 2.3, at least OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
12523 required to use this feature. It can be configured by adding each file in
12524 the configuration, which is the recommended way, or by using a "cert
12525 bundle".
12526
12527 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
12528 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
12529 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
12530 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
12531 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
12532 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
12533 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
12534 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012535
12536 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12537
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012538 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012539 a cert bundle.
12540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012541 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012542 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12543 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12544 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12545 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12546 provide multi-cert support.
12547
12548 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12549
12550 Filename | CN | SAN
12551 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12552 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012553 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012554 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12555 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12556
12557 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12558 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12559 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12560 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012561 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12562 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12563 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012564
12565 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12566 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12567
12568 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12569 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12570 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12571
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012572crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012574 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012575 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012576 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012577
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012578crt-list <file>
12579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012580 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12581 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012582
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012583 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12584
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012585 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12586 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12587 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12588 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12589 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012590
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012591 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12592 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12593 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12594 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12595 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12596 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12597 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12598 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012599
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012600 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012601 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012602 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12603 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12604 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012605
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012606 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12607
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012608 crt-list file example:
12609 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012610 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012611 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012612 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012613 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012614
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012615defer-accept
12616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12617 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12618 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012619 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012620 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12621 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12622 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12623 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12624 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12625 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12626 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12627
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012628expose-fd listeners
12629 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12630 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012631 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12632 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012633 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012634
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012635force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012636 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012637 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012638 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012639 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012640
12641force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012642 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012643 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012645
12646force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012648 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012649 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012650
12651force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012652 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012653 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012654 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012655
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012656force-tlsv13
12657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12658 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012660
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012661generate-certificates
12662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12663 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12664 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12665 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12666 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12667 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12668 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12669 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12670 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12671 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12672 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12673
12674 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12675 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012676 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012677 certificate is used many times.
12678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012679gid <gid>
12680 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12681 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12682 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12683 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12684 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12685
12686group <group>
12687 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12688 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12689 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12690 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12691 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12692
12693id <id>
12694 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12695 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12696 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12697 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12698
12699interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012700 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12701 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12702 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12703 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12704 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12705 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012706 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12707 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12708 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12709 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12710 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12711 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012712
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012713level <level>
12714 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12715 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12716 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012718 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12719 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12720 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012721 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012722 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012724 all counters).
12725
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012726severity-output <format>
12727 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12728 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12729 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12730 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12731 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12732 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12733 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12734 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12735 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12736 rfc5424 convention.
12737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012738maxconn <maxconn>
12739 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12740 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12741 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12742 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12743 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12744 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12745 eat all memory.
12746
12747mode <mode>
12748 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12749 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12750 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12751 UNIX sockets.
12752
12753mss <maxseg>
12754 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12755 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12756 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12757 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12758 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12759 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12760 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12761 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12762 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12763 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12764 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12765
12766name <name>
12767 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12768 page.
12769
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012770namespace <name>
12771 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12772 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12773 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12774 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012776nice <nice>
12777 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12778 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12779 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12780 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12781 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12782 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12783 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12784 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12785 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12786 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12787 one for an RDP socket.
12788
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012789no-ca-names
12790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12791 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012792 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012793
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012794no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012795 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012796 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012798 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012799 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12800 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012801
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012802no-tls-tickets
12803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12804 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12805 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012806 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12807 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012808 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12809 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12810 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012811
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012812no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012814 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012815 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012816 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012817 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12818 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012820no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012822 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012823 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012824 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012825 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12826 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012827
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012828no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012830 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012831 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012832 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012833 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12834 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012835
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012836no-tlsv13
12837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12838 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12839 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12840 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012841 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12842 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012843
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012844npn <protocols>
12845 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12846 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12847 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012848 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012849 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012850 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12851 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12852 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12853 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12854 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012855
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012856prefer-client-ciphers
12857 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12858 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12859 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012860 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12861 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12862 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012863
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012864process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012865 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012866 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012867 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012868 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12869 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12870 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12871 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012873 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12874 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12875 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12876 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12877 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012878
12879 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12880
12881 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12882 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12883 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12884 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12885 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12886 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12887 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12888 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012889
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012890proto <name>
12891 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12892 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12893 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12894 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012895 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012896 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012897 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012898 h2" on the bind line.
12899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012900ssl
12901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012902 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012903 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12904 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012905 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12906 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012907
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012908ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12909 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012910 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12911 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12912 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012913 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12914
12915ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012916 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12917 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12918 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12919 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012920
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012921strict-sni
12922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12923 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12924 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12925 See the "crt" option for more information.
12926
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012927tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012928 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012929 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12930 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012931 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012932 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12933 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12934 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12935 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12936 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12937 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12938 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12939
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012940tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012941 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012942 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12943 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12944 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12945 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12946 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12947 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12948 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012949 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12950 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12951 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012952
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012953tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12954 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012955 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12956 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12957 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12958 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12959 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12960 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12961 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12962 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12963 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12964 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012965 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12966 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012968transparent
12969 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12970 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12971 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12972 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12973 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12974 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12975 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12976 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12977 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12978 so check for support with your vendor.
12979
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012980v4v6
12981 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12982 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12983 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12984 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012985 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012986
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012987v6only
12988 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12989 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12990 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012991 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12992 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012994uid <uid>
12995 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12996 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12997 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12998 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12999 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13000
13001user <user>
13002 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13003 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13004 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13005 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13006 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13007
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013008verify [none|optional|required]
13009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13010 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13011 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13012 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13013 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013014 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13015 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13016 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13017 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130195.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013020------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013022The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13023which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13024arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13025settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13026after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13027Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13028address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013030 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013031 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013033Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13034keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013036The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013037
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013038addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013039 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013040 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13041 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13042 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13043 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13044 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013045
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013046agent-check
13047 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013048 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013049 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13050 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13051 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013052
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013053 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013054 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013055 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13056 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13057 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013058
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013059 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13060 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13061 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13062 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13063 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013064
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013065 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013066 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013067
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013068 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13069 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13070 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013071
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013072 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13073 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13074 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013076 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
13077 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13078 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13079 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13080 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013082 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013084 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13085 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013086
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013087 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13088 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13089 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13090 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13091 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13092 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13093 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13094 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13095 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013096
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013097 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13098 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013099 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13100 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13101 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013102 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013103
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013104 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013105 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013106
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013107agent-send <string>
13108 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13109 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13110 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13111 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13112 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13113
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013114agent-inter <delay>
13115 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13116 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13117
13118 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13119 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13120 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13121 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13122 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13123 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13124 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13125 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13126 of backends use the same servers.
13127
13128 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13129
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013130agent-addr <addr>
13131 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13132
13133 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13134 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13135 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13136 hostname, it will be resolved.
13137
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013138agent-port <port>
13139 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13140
13141 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13142
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013143allow-0rtt
13144 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013145 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13146 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013147
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013148alpn <protocols>
13149 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13150 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13151 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013152 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013153 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13154 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13155 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13156 now obsolete NPN extension.
13157 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13158 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13159
13160 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013162backup
13163 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13164 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13165 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13166 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013167 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13168 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013169
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013170ca-file <cafile>
13171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13172 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13173 server's certificate.
13174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013175check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013176 This option enables health checks on a server:
13177 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13178 considered available.
13179 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13180 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13181 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13182 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13183 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13184 set.
13185 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13186 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13187 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13188 exchanges succeed.
13189
13190 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13191 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13192 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13193 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13194 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013195 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013196 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13197
13198 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13199 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13200
13201 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13202 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13203
13204 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13205 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13206 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13207 available.
13208
13209 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13210 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13211 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13212
13213 Example:
13214 # simple tcp check
13215 backend foo
13216 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13217 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13218 backend foo
13219 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13220 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13221 backend foo
13222 option tcp-check
13223 tcp-check connect
13224 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013225
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013226check-send-proxy
13227 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13228 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13229 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13230 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13231 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13232 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13233 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13234
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013235check-alpn <protocols>
13236 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13237 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13238 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13239
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013240check-proto <name>
13241 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13242 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13243 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13244 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013245 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013246 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13247 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13248
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013249check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013250 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013251 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13252 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013253
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013254check-ssl
13255 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13256 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13257 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13258 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013259 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013260 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13261 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013263 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13264 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013265
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013266check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013267 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013268 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13269 for normal traffic.
13270
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013271ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13273 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13274 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013275 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13276 information and recommendations see e.g.
13277 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13278 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13279 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013280
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013281ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13283 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13284 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13285 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013286 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13287 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13288 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013290cookie <value>
13291 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13292 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13293 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13294 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13295 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13296 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13297 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13298
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013299crl-file <crlfile>
13300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13301 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13302 to verify server's certificate.
13303
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013304crt <cert>
13305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13306 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13307 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13308 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13309 certificate request.
13310
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013311disabled
13312 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13313 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13314 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13315 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13316 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013317 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013318
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013319enabled
13320 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13321 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13322 default value.
13323 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13324 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013326error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013327 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13328 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13329 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013331 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013333fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013334 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13335 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13336 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13337
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013338force-sslv3
13339 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13340 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013341 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013342 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013343
13344force-tlsv10
13345 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013346 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013347 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013348
13349force-tlsv11
13350 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013351 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013352 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013353
13354force-tlsv12
13355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013356 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013357 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013358
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013359force-tlsv13
13360 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13361 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013362 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013364id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013365 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13366 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13367 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013369init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13370 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13371 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013373 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13374 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13375 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13376 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13377 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13378 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13379 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13380 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13381 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013383 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13384 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13385 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13386 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13387 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13388 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013390
13391 Example:
13392 defaults
13393 # never fail on address resolution
13394 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013396inter <delay>
13397fastinter <delay>
13398downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013399 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13400 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13401 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13402 between checks depending on the server state :
13403
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013404 Server state | Interval used
13405 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13406 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13407 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13408 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13409 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13410 or yet unchecked. |
13411 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13412 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13413 | "inter" otherwise.
13414 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013416 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13417 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13418 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13419 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013420 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13421 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13422 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13423 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13424 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013425
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013426log-proto <logproto>
13427 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13428 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13429 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13430 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013432maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013433 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13434 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013435 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13436 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013437 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13438 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13439 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13440 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13441
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013442 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13443 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13444 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13445 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13446 than 50 concurrent requests.
13447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013448maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013449 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13450 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13451 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13452 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13453 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13454 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13455 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13456
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013457max-reuse <count>
13458 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13459 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13460 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13461 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13462 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13463 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13464 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13465 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013467minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013468 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13469 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13470 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13471 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13472 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13473 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013474 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013475 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013476
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013477namespace <name>
13478 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13479 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13480 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13481 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13482
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013483no-agent-check
13484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13486 default value.
13487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13488 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13489
13490no-backup
13491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13493 default value.
13494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13495 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13496
13497no-check
13498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13500 default value.
13501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13502 "default-server" "check" setting.
13503
13504no-check-ssl
13505 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13506 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13507 default value.
13508 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13509 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13510
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013511no-send-proxy
13512 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13513 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13514 default value.
13515 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13516 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13517
13518no-send-proxy-v2
13519 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13520 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13521 default value.
13522 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13523 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13524
13525no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13526 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13527 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13528 default value.
13529 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13530 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13531
13532no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13533 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13534 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13535 default value.
13536 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13537 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13538
13539no-ssl
13540 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13541 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13542 default value.
13543 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13544 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13545
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013546no-ssl-reuse
13547 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13548 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13549 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13550 and for paranoid users.
13551
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013552no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013553 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13554 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013555 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013556
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013557 Supported in default-server: No
13558
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013559no-tls-tickets
13560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13561 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13562 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013563 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13564 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013565 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13566 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13567 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013568 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013570no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013571 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013576 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013577
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013578 Supported in default-server: No
13579
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013580no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013581 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013582 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13583 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013584 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13585 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013586 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013587
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013588 Supported in default-server: No
13589
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013590no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013591 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013592 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13593 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013594 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13595 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013596 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013597
13598 Supported in default-server: No
13599
13600no-tlsv13
13601 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13602 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13603 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13604 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13605 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013606 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013607
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013608 Supported in default-server: No
13609
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013610no-verifyhost
13611 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13612 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13613 default value.
13614 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13615 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013616
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013617no-tfo
13618 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13619 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13620 default value.
13621 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13622 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13623
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013624non-stick
13625 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13626 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13627 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13628
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013629npn <protocols>
13630 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13631 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13632 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013633 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013634 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13635 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13636 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013638observe <mode>
13639 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13640 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13641 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13642 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13643 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13644 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013645 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013646
13647 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013649on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013650 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13651 Currently, four modes are available:
13652 - fastinter: force fastinter
13653 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13654 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13655 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13656 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13657
13658 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13659
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013660on-marked-down <action>
13661 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13662 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013663 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13664 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13665 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13666 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13667 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13668 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13669 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13670 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013671
13672 Actions are disabled by default
13673
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013674on-marked-up <action>
13675 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13676 Currently one action is available:
13677 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13678 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13679 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13680 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013681 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13682 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013683 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13684 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13685
13686 Actions are disabled by default
13687
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013688pool-low-conn <max>
13689 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13690 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13691 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13692 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13693 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13694 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13695 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13696 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13697 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13698 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13699 applying to "http-reuse".
13700
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013701pool-max-conn <max>
13702 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13703 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13704 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13705 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13706 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13707 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13708
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013709pool-purge-delay <delay>
13710 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013711 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013712 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013714port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013715 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13716 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13717 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13718 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13719 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13720 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13721
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013722proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013723 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13724 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13725 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13726 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013727 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013728 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013730redir <prefix>
13731 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13732 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13733 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13734 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13735 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13736 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13737 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13738 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013739 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013740 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013741 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13742 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13743 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13744 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13745
13746 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013748rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013749 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13750 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13751 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13752
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013753resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13754 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13755 server.
13756
13757 Available options:
13758
13759 * allow-dup-ip
13760 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13761 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13762 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13763 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13764 For such case, simply enable this option.
13765 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13766
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013767 * ignore-weight
13768 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13769 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13770 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13771
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013772 * prevent-dup-ip
13773 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13774 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13775 same fqdn.
13776 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13777
13778 Example:
13779 backend b_myapp
13780 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13781 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13782 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13783
13784 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13785 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13786 it
13787 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13788 different address
13789
13790 Default value: not set
13791
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013792resolve-prefer <family>
13793 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13794 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13795 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13796 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13797
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013798 Default value: ipv6
13799
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013800 Example:
13801
13802 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013803
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013804resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013805 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013806 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013807 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13809 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013810 configured network, another address is selected.
13811
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013812 Example:
13813
13814 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013815
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013816resolvers <id>
13817 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13818 hostname.
13819
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013820 Example:
13821
13822 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013823
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013824 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013825
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013826send-proxy
13827 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13828 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13829 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13830 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013831 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13832 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13833 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13834 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13835 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13836 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13837 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13838 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13839 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13840 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013841 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13842 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013843
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013844send-proxy-v2
13845 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13846 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13847 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13848 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013849 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13850 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13851 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13852 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013853
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013854proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013855 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13856 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13857
13858 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13859 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13860 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13861 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13862 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13863 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13864 connection is supported).
13865 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13866 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13867 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13868 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13869 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13870 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13871 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013872
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013873send-proxy-v2-ssl
13874 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13875 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13876 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13877 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13878 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13879 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13880 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013881 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13882 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013883
13884send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13885 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13886 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13887 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13888 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13889 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13890 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13891 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13892 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013893 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13894 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013896slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013897 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13898 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13899 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13900 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13901 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13902 parameters :
13903
13904 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13905 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13906
13907 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13908 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13909 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13910 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13911
13912 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13913 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13914 seen as failed.
13915
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013916sni <expression>
13917 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13918 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13919 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13920 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013921 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13922 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013923 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013924 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13925 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013926
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013927source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013928source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013929source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013930 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13931 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13932 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13933 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13934
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013935 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13936 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13937 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13938 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13939 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13940 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13941 server.
13942
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013943 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13944 specifying the source address without port(s).
13945
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013946ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013947 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13948 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13949 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13950 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13951 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13952 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013953 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13954 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013955
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013956ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13957 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13958 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13959 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13960
13961ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13962 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13963 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13964 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13965
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013966ssl-reuse
13967 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13968 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13969 default value.
13970 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13971 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13972
13973stick
13974 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13975 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13976 default value.
13977 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13978 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013979
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013980socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013981 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013982 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13983 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13984
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013985tcp-ut <delay>
13986 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13987 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13988 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013989 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013990 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13991 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13992 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13993 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13994 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13995 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13996 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13997 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13998 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13999
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014000tfo
14001 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14002 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14003 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14004 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14005 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014006 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014008track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014009 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14010 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14011 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14012 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014013 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14014
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014015tls-tickets
14016 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14017 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14018 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014019 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14020 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14021 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014022 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014023 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014024
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014025verify [none|required]
14026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014027 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014028 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14029 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014030 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014031 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14032 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14033 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14034 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14035 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14036 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14037 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14038 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014039
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014040verifyhost <hostname>
14041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014042 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14043 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14044 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14045 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14046 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14047 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14048 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14049 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014051weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014052 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14053 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14054 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014055 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14056 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14057 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14058 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14059 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14060 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014061
14062
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140635.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14064-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014065
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014066HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14067using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14068configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014069This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14070can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14071workload.
14072This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14073resolution at run time.
14074Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14075carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14076
14077
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140785.3.1. Global overview
14079----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014080
14081As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14082different steps of the process life:
14083
14084 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14085 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14086 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14087
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014088 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14089 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014090
14091A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14092 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14093 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14094 resolution to know this new IP.
14095
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014096When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014098SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14099from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14100will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14101will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014102
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014103A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014104 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014105 first valid response.
14106
14107 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14108 servers return an error.
14109
14110
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141115.3.2. The resolvers section
14112----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014113
14114This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014115HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14116contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014117
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014118When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14119uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14120is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14121answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14122
14123When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014124used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014125
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014126 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14127 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14128 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014129
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014130 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14131 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014132
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014133 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14134 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14135 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014136
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014137For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14138following scenarios are possible:
14139
14140 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14141 ignored
14142
14143 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14144 applied
14145
14146 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14147 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14148
14149 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14150 retries the query with a new type
14151
14152 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14153 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014154
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014155As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14156a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014157<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014158
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014159
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014160resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014162
14163A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14164
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014165accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014167 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014168 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14169 by RFC 6891)
14170
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014171 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14172
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014173nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14174 DNS server description:
14175 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14176 <ip> : IP address of the server
14177 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14178
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014179parse-resolv-conf
14180 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14181 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14182 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14183
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184hold <status> <period>
14185 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14186 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014187 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014188 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014189 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14190 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14191 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14192
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014193 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195resolve_retries <nb>
14196 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14197 giving up.
14198 Default value: 3
14199
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014200 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14201 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14202 type.
14203
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014204timeout <event> <time>
14205 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14206 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14207 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014208 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14209 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014210 Default value: 1s
14211 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014212 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014213 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014214 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14215 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14216
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014217 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014218
14219 resolvers mydns
14220 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14221 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014222 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014223 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014224 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014225 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014226 hold other 30s
14227 hold refused 30s
14228 hold nx 30s
14229 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014230 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014231 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014232
14233
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142346. Cache
14235---------
14236
14237HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14238(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14239RAM.
14240
14241The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14242this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14243
14244If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14245independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14246when we try to allocate a new one.
14247
14248The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14249
14250It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14251"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14252for more details.
14253
14254When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14255replaced by "<CACHE>".
14256
14257
142586.1. Limitation
14259----------------
14260
14261The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14262
14263- If the response is not a 200
14264- If the response contains a Vary header
14265- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14266- If the response is not cacheable
14267
14268- If the request is not a GET
14269- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14270- If the request contains an Authorization header
14271
14272
142736.2. Setup
14274-----------
14275
14276To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14277the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14278
14279
142806.2.1. Cache section
14281---------------------
14282
14283cache <name>
14284 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14285 size of cache is mandatory.
14286
14287total-max-size <megabytes>
14288 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14289 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14290
14291max-object-size <bytes>
14292 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14293 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14294 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14295
14296max-age <seconds>
14297 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14298 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14299 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14300 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14301 default.
14302
14303
143046.2.2. Proxy section
14305---------------------
14306
14307http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14308 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14309 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14310 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14311 after this one.
14312
14313http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14314 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14315 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14316 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14317 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14318
14319
14320Example:
14321
14322 backend bck1
14323 mode http
14324
14325 http-request cache-use foobar
14326 http-response cache-store foobar
14327 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14328
14329 cache foobar
14330 total-max-size 4
14331 max-age 240
14332
14333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143347. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14335----------------------------------
14336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14339The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14340these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14341but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14342data called patterns.
14343
14344
143457.1. ACL basics
14346---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014347
14348The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14349content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14350from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14351simple :
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014354 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14356 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14359adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014360
14361In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014363 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014364
14365This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14366Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14367and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014368an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14369conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14370as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14371are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014372
14373ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14374'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14375which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14376
14377There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14378performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14381specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14382this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014383methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14384ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385
14386Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14387 - boolean
14388 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14389 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14390 - string
14391 - data block
14392
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014393Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14394converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14395would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14396The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14397which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14398
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014399Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14400keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14401fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14402which are summarized in the table below :
14403
14404 +---------------------+-----------------+
14405 | Sample or converter | Default |
14406 | output type | matching method |
14407 +---------------------+-----------------+
14408 | boolean | bool |
14409 +---------------------+-----------------+
14410 | integer | int |
14411 +---------------------+-----------------+
14412 | ip | ip |
14413 +---------------------+-----------------+
14414 | string | str |
14415 +---------------------+-----------------+
14416 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14417 +---------------------+-----------------+
14418
14419Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14420matching method, see below.
14421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14423 - boolean
14424 - integer or integer range
14425 - IP address / network
14426 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14427 - regular expression
14428 - hex block
14429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014430The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14431
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014432 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14433 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014435 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014436 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014437 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014438 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14441read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14442if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14443lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14444will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14445beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14446a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14447lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14448exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14449
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014450The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14451parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14452ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14453a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14454check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14455
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014456The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14457socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14458file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14461loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14462
14463 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14464
14465In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14466the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14467case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14468as well.
14469
14470The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14471sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14472do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14473methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14474is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014475obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14477default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14478that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14479string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14480
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014481The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14482By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14483string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14484resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14485server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014486waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014487flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14488function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14491sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14492be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014493
14494 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14495 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14497 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14498 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14499 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014500
14501 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14502 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014504
14505 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014507
14508 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014511 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014512 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14513
14514 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14515 binary or string samples.
14516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14518 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14521 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14522 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14525 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14528 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14531 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14534 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014535 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14538 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14539 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014540
14541For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14542request, it is possible to do :
14543
14544 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14545
14546In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14547buffer, one would use the following acl :
14548
14549 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14550
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014551On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14552possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14553
14554 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14557criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14558method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14559to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14560criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14561the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014564the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14565For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14568 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14569 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14570 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014571
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014572
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014573The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14574types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14575combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14576brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14577default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 +-------------------------------------------------+
14580 | Input sample type |
14581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014582 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14584 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014586 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014588 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014590 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014592 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014594 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014596 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014598 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014600 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014602 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014604 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014606 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14608 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014610
14611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146127.1.1. Matching booleans
14613------------------------
14614
14615In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14616Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14617When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14618that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14619
14620Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14621return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14622"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146257.1.2. Matching integers
14626------------------------
14627
14628Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14629enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14630to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14631
14632Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14633matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14634lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014635
14636For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14637unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14638representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14639
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014640As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14641two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14642instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14643ranges and operators.
14644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014645For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014646operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14647Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14648of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014650Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014651
14652 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14653 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14654 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14655 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14656 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014658For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014659
14660 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14661
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014662This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14663
14664 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146677.1.3. Matching strings
14668-----------------------
14669
14670String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14671different forms :
14672
14673 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014674 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675
14676 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014677 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678
14679 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14680 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14681
14682 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14683 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14684
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014685 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014686 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14687 matches.
14688
14689 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14690 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14691 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014692
14693String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14694exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14695characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14696string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14697to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014698before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014699
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014700Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14701(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14702Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14703
14704Example:
14705 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14706 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147097.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14710---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014711
14712Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14713they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14714possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14715passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14716the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014717the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14718match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014719
14720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147217.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14722-------------------------------------
14723
14724It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14725not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14726a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14727to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14728digits may be used upper or lower case.
14729
14730Example :
14731 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14732 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14733
14734
147357.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14736---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014737
14738IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14739netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14740within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014741host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014742difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14743at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14744does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14745parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014746
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014747The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14748abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14749
14750 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14751 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14752 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14753 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14754 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14755 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14756 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14757 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14758
14759Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14760192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14761
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014762IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14763Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14764trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14765IPv6 patterns.
14766
14767HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14768following situations :
14769 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14770 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14771 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14772 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14773 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14774 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14775 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14776 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14777 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14778 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780
147817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14782----------------------------------
14783
14784Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14785combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14786
14787 - AND (implicit)
14788 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14789 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14796indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14799"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14800requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14801is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14802
14803 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014804 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14805 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14806 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807
14808To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14809and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14810
14811 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14812 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14813 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14814 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14815
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014816 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14818 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14819 use_backend www if host_www
14820
14821It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14822expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14823be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14824the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14825
14826 The following rule :
14827
14828 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014829 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830
14831 Can also be written that way :
14832
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014833 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834
14835It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14836to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14837simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14838sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14839good use is the following :
14840
14841 With named ACLs :
14842
14843 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14844 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14845 monitor fail if site_dead
14846
14847 With anonymous ACLs :
14848
14849 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14850
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014851See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14852keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853
14854
148557.3. Fetching samples
14856---------------------
14857
14858Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14859against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14860sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14861ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14862of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14863available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14864
14865This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14866Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14867compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14868deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14869
14870The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14871matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14872method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14873indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14874
14875As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14876when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14877mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14878the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14879ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14880
14881Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14882multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14883when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014884incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14885are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14887all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14888
14889Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14890 - name
14891 - name(arg1)
14892 - name(arg1,arg2)
14893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014894
148957.3.1. Converters
14896-----------------
14897
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014898Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14899of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14900is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14901was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014902has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014903unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14904
14905These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14906sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14907the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014908support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014909
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014910A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14911support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14912supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14913(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14914bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014917
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001491851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14919 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14920 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14921 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14922 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14923 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14924
14925 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014926 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14927 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014928 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14929 frontend http-in
14930 bind *:8081
14931 default_backend servers
14932 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14933 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14934
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014935add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014936 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014937 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014938 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14939 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014940 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014941 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14942 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14943 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14944 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014946 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014947
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014948aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14949 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14950 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14951 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14952 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14953 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14954 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14955
14956 Example:
14957 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14958 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14959
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014960and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014961 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014962 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014963 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14964 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014965 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014966 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14967 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14968 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14969 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014971 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014972
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014973b64dec
14974 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14975 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14976
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014977base64
14978 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014979 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014980 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14981
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014982bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014983 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014984 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014985 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014986 presence of a flag).
14987
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014988bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14989 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14990 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014991 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014992
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014993concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14994 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14995 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14996 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14997 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14998 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14999 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15000 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15001 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15002 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15003 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015004 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015005 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015006 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15007 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015008
15009 Example:
15010 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15011 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15012 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015013 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015014 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15015
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015016cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015017 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15018 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015019
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015020crc32([<avalanche>])
15021 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15022 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15023 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15024 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15025 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15026 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15027 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15028 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15029 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15030 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015031 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15032
15033crc32c([<avalanche>])
15034 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15035 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15036 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15037 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15038 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15039 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15040 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15041 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015042
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015043cut_crlf
15044 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15045 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15046 updated.
15047
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015048da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015049 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15050 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15051 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15052 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015053 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015054 configuration language.
15055
15056 Example:
15057 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015058 bind *:8881
15059 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015060 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015061
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015062debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15063 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15064 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15065 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15066 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15067 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15068 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15069 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15070 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15071 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15072 printable sample types.
15073
15074 Example:
15075 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015076
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015077digest(<algorithm>)
15078 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15079 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15080
15081 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15082 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15083
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015084div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015085 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15086 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015087 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015088 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15089 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015090 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015091 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15092 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15093 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15094 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015096 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015097
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015098djb2([<avalanche>])
15099 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15100 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15101 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15102 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15103 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15104 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15105 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015106 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15107 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015108
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015109even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015110 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015111 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15112
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015113field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15114 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15115 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15116 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15117 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15118 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15119 fields.
15120
15121 Example :
15122 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15123 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15124 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015127
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015128hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015130 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015132 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015133
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015134hex2i
15135 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015136 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015137
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015138htonl
15139 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15140 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15141 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15142 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15143
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015144hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15145 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15146 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15147 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15148 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15149
15150 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15151 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15152
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015153http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015154 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15155 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015156 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15157 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15158 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15159 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15160 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15161 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15162 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15163 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015165iif(<true>,<false>)
15166 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15167 string otherwise.
15168
15169 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015170 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015171
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015172in_table(<table>)
15173 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15174 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15175 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015176 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015177 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15178
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015179ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15180 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015181 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015182 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15183 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15184 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15185 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15186 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015187
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015188json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015189 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015190 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015191 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015192 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15193 of errors:
15194 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15195 bytes, ...)
15196 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15197 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15198
15199 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15200 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15201 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15202 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15203 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15204 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205 - "ascii" : never fails;
15206 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15207 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015208 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015210 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15211 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15212
15213 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015214 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015215
15216 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015217 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015218 capture request header user-agent len 150
15219 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015220
15221 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15222 GET / HTTP/1.0
15223 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15224
15225 Output log:
15226 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015228language(<value>[,<default>])
15229 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15230 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15231 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15232 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15233 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15234 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15235 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15236 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15237 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015238 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015239 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15240 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015242 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015244 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15245 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015247 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15248 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15249 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15250 use_backend spanish if es
15251 use_backend french if fr
15252 use_backend english if en
15253 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015254
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015255length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015256 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15257 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15258 type. The result is of type integer.
15259
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015260lower
15261 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15262 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15263 type. The result is of type string.
15264
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015265ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15266 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15267 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15268 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15269 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15270 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15271 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15272
15273 Example :
15274
15275 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015276 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015277 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15278
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015279ltrim(<chars>)
15280 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15281 representation of the input sample.
15282
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015283map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15284map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15285map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15286 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15287 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15288 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15289 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15290 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15291 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15292 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15293 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015294
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015295 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15296 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15297 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015298
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015299 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015300 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015301
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015302 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15303 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15304 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15305 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015306 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15307 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015308 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15310 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15312 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15314 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015316 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15318 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15320 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15322 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015324
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015325 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15326 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15327 the corresponding match text.
15328
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015329 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15330 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15331 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15332 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15333 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015335 Example :
15336
15337 # this is a comment and is ignored
15338 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15339 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15340 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15341 | | | `---------- value
15342 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15343 | `---------------------------- key
15344 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15345
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015346mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015347 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15348 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015349 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015350 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15355 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015357 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015358
15359mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015360 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015361 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15362 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015372
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015373nbsrv
15374 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15375 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15376 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15377 map lookup.
15378
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015379neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015380 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15381 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15382 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15383 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015384
15385not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015386 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015387 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015388 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015389 absence of a flag).
15390
15391odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015392 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015393 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15394
15395or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015396 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015397 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015398 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15399 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15403 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15404 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015406 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015407
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015408protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15409 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15410 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15411 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15412 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15413 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15414 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15415 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15416 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15417 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15418 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15419 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15420
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015421regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015422 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15423 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15424 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15425 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15426 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15427 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15428 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15429 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15430 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015431 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15432 of characters with other ones.
15433
15434 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15435 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15436 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15437 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15438 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15439 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015440
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015441 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015442
15443 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15444 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15445 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015446 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015447
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015448 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15449 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15450
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015451 # capture groups and backreferences
15452 # both lines do the same.
15453 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15454 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15455
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015456capture-req(<id>)
15457 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15458 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15459
15460 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015461 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15462 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015463
15464capture-res(<id>)
15465 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15466 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15467
15468 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015469 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15470 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015471
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015472rtrim(<chars>)
15473 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15474 of the input sample.
15475
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015476sdbm([<avalanche>])
15477 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15478 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15479 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15480 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15481 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15482 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15483 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015484 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15485 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015486
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015487secure_memcmp(<var>)
15488 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15489 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15490 match.
15491
15492 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15493 performed in constant time.
15494
15495 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15496 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15497
15498 Example :
15499
15500 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15501 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15502 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15503 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15504
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015505set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015506 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15507 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15508 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015509 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015510 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15511 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015512 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015513 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15514 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015515 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015516 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015517
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015518sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015519 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015520 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15521
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015522sha2([<bits>])
15523 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15524 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15525
15526 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15527 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15528
15529 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15530 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15531
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015532srv_queue
15533 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15534 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15535 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15536 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15537 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15538
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015539strcmp(<var>)
15540 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15541 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15542 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15543 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15544 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15545 shorter).
15546
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015547 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15548 strings in constant time.
15549
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015550 Example :
15551
15552 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15553 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15554 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15555
15556
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015557sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015558 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15559 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015560 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015561 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15562 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015566 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15568 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015569 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015570 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015571
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015572table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15573 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15574 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15575 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15576 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15577 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15578 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15579
15580
15581table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15582 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15583 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15584 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15585 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15586 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15587 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15588
15589table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015593 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15594 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15595
15596table_conn_cur(<table>)
15597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15600 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15601 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15602
15603table_conn_rate(<table>)
15604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15607 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15608 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15609
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015610table_gpt0(<table>)
15611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15614 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15615 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15616
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015617table_gpc0(<table>)
15618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15620 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15621 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15622 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15623
15624table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15625 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15626 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15627 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15628 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15629 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15630 sample fetch keyword.
15631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015632table_gpc1(<table>)
15633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15636 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15637 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15638
15639table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15640 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15641 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15642 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15643 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15644 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15645 sample fetch keyword.
15646
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015647table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015651 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15652 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15653
15654table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15657 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15658 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15659 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15660 keyword.
15661
15662table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015666 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15667 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15668
15669table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15672 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15673 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15674 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15675 keyword.
15676
15677table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015681 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15682 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15683 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15684 keyword.
15685
15686table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015689 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015690 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15691 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15692 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15693 keyword.
15694
15695table_server_id(<table>)
15696 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15697 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15698 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15699 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15700 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15701 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15702
15703table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15704 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15705 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015706 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015707 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15708 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15709 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15710 keyword.
15711
15712table_sess_rate(<table>)
15713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15716 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15717 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15718 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15719 keyword.
15720
15721table_trackers(<table>)
15722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15725 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15726 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15727 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15728 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15729 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15730 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15731 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15732
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015733upper
15734 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15735 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15736 type. The result is of type string.
15737
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015738url_dec([<in_form>])
15739 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15740 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15741 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15742 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15743 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15744 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015745
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015746ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015747 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015748 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15749 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15750 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015751 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15752 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15753 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15754 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015755 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015756 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15757 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015758
15759 Example:
15760 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15761 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15762
15763 message Point {
15764 int32 latitude = 1;
15765 int32 longitude = 2;
15766 }
15767
15768 message PPoint {
15769 Point point = 59;
15770 }
15771
15772 message Rectangle {
15773 // One corner of the rectangle.
15774 PPoint lo = 48;
15775 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15776 PPoint hi = 49;
15777 }
15778
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015779 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15780 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15781 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015782
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015783 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15784 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015785 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015786 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15787
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015788 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015789
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015790 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015791
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015792 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15793 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15794 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015795
15796 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15797 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15798 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15799
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015800 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15801 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15802 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015803
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015804
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015805unset-var(<var name>)
15806 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15807 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15811 response),
15812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15816
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015817utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15818 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15819 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15820 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15821 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15822 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15823 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15824
15825 Example :
15826
15827 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015828 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015829 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15830
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015831word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15832 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15833 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15834 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015835 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015836 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15837 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15838
15839 Example :
15840 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15841 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15842 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15843 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15844 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015845 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015846
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015847wt6([<avalanche>])
15848 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15849 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15850 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15851 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15852 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15853 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15854 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015855 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15856 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015858xor(<value>)
15859 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015860 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015861 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015862 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015863 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015864 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15865 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015866 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015867 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015869 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015870 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015872xxh32([<seed>])
15873 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15874 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15875 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15876 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15877 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15878 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15879 as cryptographically secure.
15880
15881xxh64([<seed>])
15882 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15883 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15884 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15885 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15886 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15887 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15888 as cryptographically secure.
15889
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015890
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158917.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892--------------------------------------------
15893
15894A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15895not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15896"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15897The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15898
15899always_false : boolean
15900 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15901 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15902
15903always_true : boolean
15904 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15905 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15906
15907avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015908 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15910 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15911 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15912 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15913 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15914 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15915 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15916 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15917 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15918 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15919 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15920 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15921 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015924 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15925 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15926 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15927 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015928 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15929
15930be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15932 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15933 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15934 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15935 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015936 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15937 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015938
15939 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15940 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15941 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15945 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15946 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15949 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015950
15951 Example :
15952 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15953 backend dynamic
15954 mode http
15955 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15956 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015959 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15960 of the string.
15961
15962bool(<bool>) : bool
15963 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15964 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015968 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15970 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015971
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015972 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015973 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015974 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15975
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015976 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15977 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015978
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015979 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015980 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015982 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015985 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015987 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15988 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015990 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015991
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015992cpu_calls : integer
15993 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15994 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15995 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15996 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15997 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15998 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15999
16000cpu_ns_avg : integer
16001 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16002 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16003 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16004 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16005 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16006 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16007 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16008 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16009 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16010 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16011 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16012
16013cpu_ns_tot : integer
16014 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16015 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16016 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16017 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16018 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16019 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16020 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16021 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16022 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16023 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16024 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16025 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16026 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16027
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016028date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016029 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016030
16031 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16032 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16033 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016034 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16035
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016036 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16037 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16038 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16039 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16040 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16041
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016042 Example :
16043
16044 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16045 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016046
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016047 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16048 # millisecond granularity
16049 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16050
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016051date_us : integer
16052 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16053 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16054 from the same timeval structure.
16055
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016056distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16057 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16058 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16059 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16060 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16061 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16062 list of supported tokens.
16063
16064distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16065 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16066 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16067 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16068 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16069 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16070 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16071 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16072 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16073 supported tokens.
16074
16075 Example :
16076 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16077 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16078 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16079 # send large files to the big farm
16080 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16081
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016082env(<name>) : string
16083 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16084 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16085 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16086 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16087 certain way.
16088
16089 Examples :
16090 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16091 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16092
16093 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16094 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16097 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016098 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16099 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16101 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16104 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016105
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016106fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16107 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16108 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16109 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16113 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16114 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16115 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16116 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16117 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16118 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16119 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016120
16121 Example :
16122 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16123 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16124 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16125 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16126 frontend mail
16127 bind :25
16128 mode tcp
16129 maxconn 100
16130 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16131 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16132 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16133 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016134
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016135hostname : string
16136 Returns the system hostname.
16137
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016138int(<integer>) : signed integer
16139 Returns a signed integer.
16140
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016141ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16142 Returns an ipv4.
16143
16144ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16145 Returns an ipv6.
16146
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016147lat_ns_avg : integer
16148 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16149 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16150 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16151 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16152 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16153 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16154 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16155 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16156 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016157 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16158 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16159 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16160 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16161 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16162 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016163
16164lat_ns_tot : integer
16165 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16166 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16167 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16168 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16169 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16170 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16171 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16172 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16173 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016174 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16175 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16176 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16177 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16178 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016179 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16180 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16181 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16182 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16183 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16184 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16185
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016186meth(<method>) : method
16187 Returns a method.
16188
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016189nbproc : integer
16190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16191 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16192 and debugging purposes.
16193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16196 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16197 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016198 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16199 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16200 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016201
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016202prio_class : integer
16203 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16204 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16205 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16206
16207prio_offset : integer
16208 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16209 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16210 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16211 set-priority-offset".
16212
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016213proc : integer
16214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16215 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16216 debugging purposes.
16217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016219 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16220 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16221 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16223 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16224 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16225 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16226 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16227
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016228rand([<range>]) : integer
16229 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16230 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16231 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16232 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16233 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16234
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016235uuid([<version>]) : string
16236 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16237 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16238 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16242 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16243 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16244 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16245 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016246 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16247 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16248
16249srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16251 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16252 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16253 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16254 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16255 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16256 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16257
16258 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16259 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260
16261srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16262 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16263 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16264 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016265 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16267 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16268 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16269
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016270srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16272 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16273 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16274 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16275 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16276 fetch methods.
16277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16279 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16280 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016281 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16283 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285 overloading servers).
16286
16287 Example :
16288 # Redirect to a separate back
16289 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16290 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16291 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16292
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016293srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16294 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16295 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16296 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16297
16298srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16299 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16300 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16301 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16302
16303srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16304 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16305 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16306 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16307
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016308stopping : boolean
16309 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16310 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16311 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16312
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016313str(<string>) : string
16314 Returns a string.
16315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16317 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16318 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16319
16320table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16321 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16322 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16323 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16324
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016325thread : integer
16326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16327 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16328 and debugging purposes.
16329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016330var(<var-name>) : undefined
16331 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016332 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16333 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016334 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016337 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016338 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16339 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016340 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016341 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344----------------------------------
16345
16346The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16347closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16348methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16349sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16350TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016351the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16352counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016353"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16354used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16355can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16356Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16357table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16358tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16359currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016361bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016362 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16363 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16364 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366be_id : integer
16367 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016368 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16369 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016371be_name : string
16372 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016373 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16374 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376dst : ip
16377 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16378 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16379 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16380 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016381 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16382 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16383 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16384 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16385 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16386 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387
16388dst_conn : integer
16389 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16390 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16391 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16392 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16393 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16394 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16395 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16396 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016397
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016398dst_is_local : boolean
16399 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16400 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16401 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16402 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016403 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016404 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16405 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16406 it only once per connection.
16407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408dst_port : integer
16409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16410 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16411 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16412 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16413 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16414 an HTTP header.
16415
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016416fc_http_major : integer
16417 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16418 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16419 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16420
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016421fc_pp_authority : string
16422 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16423 if any.
16424
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016425fc_pp_unique_id : string
16426 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16427 if any.
16428
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016429fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16430 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16431 header.
16432
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016433fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16434 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16435 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16436 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16437 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16438 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16439 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16440
16441fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16442 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16443 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16444 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16445 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16446 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16447 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16448
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016449fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016450 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16451 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16452 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16453 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16454
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016455fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016456 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16457 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16458 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16459 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16460
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016461fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016462 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16463 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16464 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16465 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16466
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016467fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016468 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16469 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16470 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16471 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16472
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016473fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016474 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16475 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16476 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16477 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16478
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016479fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016480 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16481 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16482 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16483 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16484
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016485fe_defbe : string
16486 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16487 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489fe_id : integer
16490 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016491 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16493
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016494fe_name : string
16495 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16496 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16497 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016499sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016500sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16501sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16502sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016503 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16504 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16505 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016507sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016508sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16509sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16510sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016511 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16512 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16513 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016515sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016516sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16517sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16518sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016519 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16520 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016521 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16522 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16523 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016524
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016525 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016526 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16527 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016528 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16529 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16530 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016531 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16532 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16533
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016534sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16535sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16536sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16537sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16538 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16539 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16540 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16541 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16542 when a first ACL was verified.
16543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016544sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016545sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16546sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16547sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016549 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016551sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016552sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16553sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16554sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016555 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16556 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16557 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016559sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016560sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16561sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16562sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016563 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16564 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16565 See also src_conn_rate.
16566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016567sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016568sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16569sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16570sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016571 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016572 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016573
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016574sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16575sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16576sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16577sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16578 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16579 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16580
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016581sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16582sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16583sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16584sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16585 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16586 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16587
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016588sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016589sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16590sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16591sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016592 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16593 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16594 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016595 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16596 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16597 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016598
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016599sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16600sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16601sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16602sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16603 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16604 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16605 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16606 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16607 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16608 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016610sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016611sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16612sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16613sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016615 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16616 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016618sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016619sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16620sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16621sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016622 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16623 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16624 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16625 src_http_err_rate.
16626
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016627sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016628sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16629sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16630sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016631 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016632 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16633 src_http_req_cnt.
16634
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016635sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016636sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16637sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16638sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016639 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16640 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16641 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16642 src_http_req_rate.
16643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016644sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016645sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16646sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16647sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016648 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016649 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16650 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16651 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16652 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016653
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016654 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016655 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16656 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16658
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016659sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16660sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16661sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16662sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16663 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16664 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16665 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16666 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16667 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016669sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016670sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16671sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16672sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016673 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16674 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16675 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016677sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016678sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16679sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16680sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016681 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16682 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16683 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016684
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016685sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016686sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16687sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16688sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016690 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16691 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16692 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016693 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016694 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016696sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016697sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16698sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16699sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016700 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16701 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16702 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16703 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16704 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016705 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016707sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016708sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16709sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16710sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016711 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16712 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16713 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016715sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016716sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16717sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16718sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016719 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16720 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016721 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016722 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16723 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16725 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16726 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728so_id : integer
16729 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16730 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16731 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016732
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016733so_name : string
16734 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16735 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16736 strings instead of integers.
16737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016738src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016739 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16741 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16742 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016743 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16744 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16745 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016746 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16747 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16748 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16749 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16750 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16751 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16752 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016753
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016754 Example:
16755 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16756 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16759 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16760 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16761 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016762 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16765 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16766 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016767 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016768 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16771 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16772 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16773 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16774 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16775 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16776 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016777
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016778 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016779 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16780 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16781 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16782 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016783 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016784 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16785 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16786
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016787src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16788 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16789 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16790 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16791 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16792 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16793 was verified.
16794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016796 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016798 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016799 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016802 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16804 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016805 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16808 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16809 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16810 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016811 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016814 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016816 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016817 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016818
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016819src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16820 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16821 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16822 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16823 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16824
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016825src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16826 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16827 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16828 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16829 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016832 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016834 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16835 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016836 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16837 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16838 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016839
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016840src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16841 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16842 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16843 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16844 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16845 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16846 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16847 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016850 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016852 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016853 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16857 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16858 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16859 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16860 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016861 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016864 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16866 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016867 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16870 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16871 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16872 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016873 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016874 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16877 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16878 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16879 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016880 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16882 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016883
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016884 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016885 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016886 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016887 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016888
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016889src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16890 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16891 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16892 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16893 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16894 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16895 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16896
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016897src_is_local : boolean
16898 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16899 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16900 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16901 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016902 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016903 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16904 once per connection.
16905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016907 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16908 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16909 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16910 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16911 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016914 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16915 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16916 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16917 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16918 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920src_port : integer
16921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16922 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16923 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16924 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016927 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016928 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16929 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16930 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016931 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16934 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16935 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16936 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16937 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016938 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16941 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16942 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16943 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16944 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16945 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16946 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16947 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16948 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016949
16950 Example :
16951 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16952 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16953 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16954 listen ssh
16955 bind :22
16956 mode tcp
16957 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016958 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016960 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016962srv_id : integer
16963 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16964 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016965 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016966
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016967srv_name : string
16968 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16969 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016970 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016973----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16976closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16977when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16978usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016979future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016980
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001698151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16982 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16983 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16984 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16985 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16986 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16987
16988 Example :
16989 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16990 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16991 # the request.
16992 frontend http-in
16993 bind *:8081
16994 default_backend servers
16995 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16996 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16997
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016998ssl_bc : boolean
16999 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17000 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017001 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17002 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017003
17004ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17005 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017006 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17007 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017008
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017009ssl_bc_alpn : string
17010 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17011 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017012 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017013 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17014 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17015 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17016 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17017 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017018 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17019 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017020
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017021ssl_bc_cipher : string
17022 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017023 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17024 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017025
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017026ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17027 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17028 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17029 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017030 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017031
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017032ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17033 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17034 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017035 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17036 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017037
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017038ssl_bc_npn : string
17039 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17040 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017041 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017042 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17043 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17044 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17045 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017046 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17047 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017048
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017049ssl_bc_protocol : string
17050 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017051 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17052 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017053
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017054ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017055 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017056 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017057 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17058 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017059
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017060ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17061 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17062 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17063 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017064 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017065
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017066ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17067 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17068 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017069 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17070 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017071
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017072ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17073 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17074 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17075 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017076 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017077
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017078ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17079 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017080 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17081 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017083ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17084 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17085 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17086 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17087 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17088 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17091 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17092 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17093 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17094 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017095
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017096ssl_c_der : binary
17097 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17098 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17099 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17100
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017101ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17102 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17103 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17104 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17105 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17106 does not support resumed sessions.
17107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108ssl_c_err : integer
17109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17110 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17111 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17112 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17113 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017114
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017115ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017116 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17117 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17118 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17119 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17120 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17121 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17122 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17123 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017124 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17125 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17126 LDAP v3.
17127 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17128 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130ssl_c_key_alg : string
17131 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17132 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17133 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135ssl_c_notafter : string
17136 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17137 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17138 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140ssl_c_notbefore : string
17141 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17142 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17143 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017144
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017145ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17147 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17148 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17149 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17150 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17151 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17152 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17153 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017154 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17155 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17156 LDAP v3.
17157 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17158 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017160ssl_c_serial : binary
17161 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17162 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17163 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17166 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17167 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17168 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017169 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17170 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17171
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017172 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017173 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17176 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17177 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17178 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180ssl_c_used : boolean
17181 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17182 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184ssl_c_verify : integer
17185 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17186 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17187 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17188 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190ssl_c_version : integer
17191 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17192 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017193
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017194ssl_f_der : binary
17195 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17196 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17197 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17198
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017199ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17201 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17202 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17206 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17207 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017208 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17209 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17210 LDAP v3.
17211 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17212 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017214ssl_f_key_alg : string
17215 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17216 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17217 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219ssl_f_notafter : string
17220 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17222 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224ssl_f_notbefore : string
17225 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17226 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17227 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017228
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017229ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17231 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17232 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17233 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17234 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17235 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17236 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17237 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017238 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17239 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17240 LDAP v3.
17241 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17242 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244ssl_f_serial : binary
17245 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17246 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17247 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017248
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017249ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17250 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17251 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17252 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17255 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17256 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17257 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259ssl_f_version : integer
17260 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17261 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17262
17263ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017264 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17265 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17266 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268 Example :
17269 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17270 listen http-https
17271 bind :80
17272 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17273 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17274
17275ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17276 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17277 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17278
17279ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017280 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17282 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17283 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17284 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17285 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17286 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17287 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17288 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290ssl_fc_cipher : string
17291 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17292 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017293
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017294ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17295 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17296 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017297 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017298
17299ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17300 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17301 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017302 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017303
17304ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17305 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17306 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17307 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017308 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017309 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017310
17311ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17312 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17313 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017314 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017315
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017316ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17317 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17318 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17319 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17320
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017321ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17322 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17323 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17324 transport layer.
17325 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17326 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17327 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17328 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17329
17330ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17331 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17332 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17333 transport layer.
17334 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17335 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17336 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17337 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17338
17339ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17340 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17341 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17342 transport layer.
17343 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17344 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17345 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17346 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17347
17348ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17349 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17350 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17351 transport layer.
17352 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17353 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17354 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17355 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17356
17357ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17358 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17359 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17360 transport layer.
17361 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17362 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17363 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17364 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017367 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17368 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017369 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17370 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17371 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17372 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017373
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017374ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17375 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17376 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17377 wait until the handshake happened.
17378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17380 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017381 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17382 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017383 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017384 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017385
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017386ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017387 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017388 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17389 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017392 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17394 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17395 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17396 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17397 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17398 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17399 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401ssl_fc_protocol : string
17402 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17403 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017404
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017405ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017407 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17408 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017409
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017410ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17411 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17412 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17413 transport layer.
17414 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17415 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17416 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17417 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17418
17419ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17420 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17421 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17422 transport layer.
17423 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17424 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17425 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17426 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17427
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017428ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17429 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17430 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17431 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17434 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17435 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17436 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17437 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017438
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017439ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17440 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17441 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17442 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17443 BoringSSL.
17444
17445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446ssl_fc_sni : string
17447 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17448 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17449 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17450 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17451 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17452
17453 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17454 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17455 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017456 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017457 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017460 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17461 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17464 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17465 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017466
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017467ssl_s_der : binary
17468 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17469 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17470 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17471
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017472ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17473 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17474 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17475 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17476 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17477 does not support resumed sessions.
17478
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017479ssl_s_key_alg : string
17480 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17481 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17482 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17483
17484ssl_s_notafter : string
17485 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17487 transport layer.
17488
17489ssl_s_notbefore : string
17490 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17491 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17492 transport layer.
17493
17494ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17495 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17496 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17497 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17498 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17499 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17500 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017501 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17502 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017503 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17504 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17505 LDAP v3.
17506 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17507 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17508
17509ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17510 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17511 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17512 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17513 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17514 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17515 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017516 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17517 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017518 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17519 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17520 LDAP v3.
17521 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17522 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17523
17524ssl_s_serial : binary
17525 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17526 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17527 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17528
17529ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17530 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17531 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17532 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17533
17534ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17535 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17536 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17537 layer.
17538
17539ssl_s_version : integer
17540 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17541 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175437.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17547sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17548only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17549For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17550be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17551can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17552sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17553for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17554content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017557 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17559 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17562 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017563 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017565
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017566req.hdrs : string
17567 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17568 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17569 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17570 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17571
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017572req.hdrs_bin : binary
17573 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17574 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17575 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17576 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17577 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17578 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17579
17580 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17581
17582 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17583 str: <int:length><bytes>
17584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585req.len : integer
17586req_len : integer (deprecated)
17587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17588 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17589 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17590 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17591 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17592 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17593 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17594 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17597 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017598 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17599 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17600 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17601 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603 ACL alternatives :
17604 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17607 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17608 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17609 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17610 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612 ACL alternatives :
17613 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617req.proto_http : boolean
17618req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17619 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17620 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17621 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17622 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17623 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17624 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17625 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627 Example:
17628 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17629 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17630 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017631 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17634rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17635 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17636 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17637 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17638 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17639 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17640 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17641 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17644 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17645 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17646 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17647 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17648 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650 ACL derivatives :
17651 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017653 Example :
17654 listen tse-farm
17655 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17656 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17657 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17658 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17659 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17660 persist rdp-cookie
17661 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17662 # This is only useful makes sense if
17663 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17664 stick-table type string size 204800
17665 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17666 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17667 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17670 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17673rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17674 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17675 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17676 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17677 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017679 ACL derivatives :
17680 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017681
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017682req.ssl_alpn : string
17683 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17684 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17685 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17686 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17687 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17688 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017689 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017690
17691 Examples :
17692 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17693 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17694 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017695 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017696 default_backend bk_default
17697
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017698req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17699 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17700 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017701 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17702 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17703 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17704 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17705 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17708req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17709 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17710 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17711 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17712 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17713 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17714 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17715 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717req.ssl_sni : string
17718req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17719 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17720 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17721 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17722 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17723 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017724 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17725 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17726 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17727 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17728 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17729 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17730 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17731 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17732 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734 ACL derivatives :
17735 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737 Examples :
17738 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17739 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17740 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17741 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17742 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017743
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017744req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17745 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17746 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17747 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17748 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17749 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17750 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17751 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17752 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17753 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755req.ssl_ver : integer
17756req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17757 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17758 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17759 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17760 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17761 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17762 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17763 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017764 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017765 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767 ACL derivatives :
17768 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017769
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017770res.len : integer
17771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17772 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17773 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17774 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17775 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17776 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17777 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017778 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17781 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017782 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017783 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017784 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017785 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17788 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17789 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17790 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017791 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17792 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017795
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017796res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17797rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17798 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17799 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17800 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17801 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17802 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17803 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17804 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806wait_end : boolean
17807 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17808 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017809 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17811 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017812 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17814 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816 Examples :
17817 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17818 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17819 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17822 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17823 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17824 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17825 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17826 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17827 tcp-request content reject
17828
17829
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178307.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831--------------------------------------
17832
17833It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17834This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17835data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17836its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17837HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17838content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17839to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17840more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17841response are indexed.
17842
17843base : string
17844 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17845 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17846 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17847 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17848 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17849 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17850 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17851 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17852
17853 ACL derivatives :
17854 base : exact string match
17855 base_beg : prefix match
17856 base_dir : subdir match
17857 base_dom : domain match
17858 base_end : suffix match
17859 base_len : length match
17860 base_reg : regex match
17861 base_sub : substring match
17862
17863base32 : integer
17864 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17865 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17866 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017867 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17868 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17869 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870
17871base32+src : binary
17872 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17873 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17874 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17875 per-URL counters.
17876
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017877capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17878 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17879 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17880 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17881
17882capture.req.method : string
17883 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17884 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17885 because it's allocated.
17886
17887capture.req.uri : string
17888 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17889 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17890 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17891 allocated.
17892
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017893capture.req.ver : string
17894 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17895 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17896 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17897
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017898capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17899 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17900 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17901 The first entry is an index of 0.
17902 See also: "capture response header"
17903
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017904capture.res.ver : string
17905 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17906 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17907 persistent flag.
17908
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017909req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017910 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17911 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17912 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017913
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017914req.body_param([<name>) : string
17915 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17916 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17917 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17918 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17919 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17920 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17921 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17922 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17923 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17924 given.
17925
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017926req.body_len : integer
17927 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17928 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017929 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17930 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017931
17932req.body_size : integer
17933 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017934 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17935 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937req.cook([<name>]) : string
17938cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17939 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17940 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17941 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17942 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17943 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17944 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17945 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17946 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17947
17948 ACL derivatives :
17949 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17950 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17951 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17952 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17953 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17954 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17955 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17956 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17959cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17960 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17961 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17964cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17965 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17966 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17967 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17968 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017970cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17971 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17972 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17973 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17974 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017975 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17977 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17978 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17979 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17982 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17983 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17984 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17985 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017986 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17989 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17990 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17991 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17992 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17993 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17994 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17995 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17996 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17999 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18000 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18001 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18002 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18005 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18006 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18007 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18008 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18009 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18010 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18011 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18012 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018013 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018015 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017 ACL derivatives :
18018 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18019 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18020 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18021 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18022 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18023 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18024 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18025 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18026
18027req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18028hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18029 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18030 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18031 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18032 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18033 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18034 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18035 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18036 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18037 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18038
18039req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18040hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18041 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18042 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18043 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18044 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18045 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018046 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18048 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18049
18050req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18051hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18052 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18053 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18054 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18055 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18056 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18057 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18058 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18059
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018060
18061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18063 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18064 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18065 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18066 basic auth is supported.
18067
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018068http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18069 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18070 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18071 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18072 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018073 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18074 basic auth is supported.
18075
18076 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018077 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18078 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18079 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18080 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018082http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018083 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18084 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18085 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018086
18087http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018088 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18089 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18090 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018091
18092http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018093 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18094 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18095 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018098 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18099 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18101 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018103method : integer + string
18104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18105 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18106 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18107 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18108 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18109 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18110 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112 ACL derivatives :
18113 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115 Example :
18116 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18117 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18118 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018120path : string
18121 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18122 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18123 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18124 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18125 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018127 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129 ACL derivatives :
18130 path : exact string match
18131 path_beg : prefix match
18132 path_dir : subdir match
18133 path_dom : domain match
18134 path_end : suffix match
18135 path_len : length match
18136 path_reg : regex match
18137 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018138
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018139pathq : string
18140 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18141 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18142 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18143 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18144 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18145 result in both cases.
18146
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018147query : string
18148 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18149 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18150 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18151 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018152 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018153 which stops before the question mark.
18154
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018155req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18156 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18157 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18158 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18159 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161req.ver : string
18162req_ver : string (deprecated)
18163 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18164 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18165 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167 ACL derivatives :
18168 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018169
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018170res.body : binary
18171 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18172 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18173 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18174 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18175
18176res.body_len : integer
18177 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18178 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18179 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18180 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18181
18182res.body_size : integer
18183 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18184 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18185 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18186 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18187 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18188 based expect rules.
18189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190res.comp : boolean
18191 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18192 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18193 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195res.comp_algo : string
18196 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18197 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18198 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200res.cook([<name>]) : string
18201scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18202 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18203 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018204 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18205 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018207 ACL derivatives :
18208 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18211scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18212 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18213 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018214 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18215 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18218scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18219 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18220 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018221 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18222 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18225 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18226 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18227 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18228 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18229 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18230 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18231 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18232 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018233 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18236 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18237 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18238 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18239 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018240 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18241 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18244shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18246 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18247 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18248 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18249 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18250 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18251 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018252 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18253 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 ACL derivatives :
18256 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18257 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18258 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18259 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18260 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18261 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18262 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18263 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18264
18265res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18266shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18267 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18268 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18269 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18270 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018271 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18274shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18275 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18276 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18277 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18278 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18279 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018280 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18281 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018282
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018283res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18284 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18285 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18286 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018287 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18288 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18291shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18292 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18293 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18294 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18295 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18296 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018297 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18298 based expect rules.
18299
18300res.hdrs : string
18301 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18302 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18303 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18304 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18305 based expect rules.
18306
18307res.hdrs_bin : binary
18308 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18309 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18310 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18311 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18312 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18313 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18314 (length of 0 for both).
18315
18316 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18317
18318 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18319 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321res.ver : string
18322resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18323 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018324 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18325 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327 ACL derivatives :
18328 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18331 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18332 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018333 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18337 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339status : integer
18340 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18341 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018342 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18343 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018344
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018345unique-id : string
18346 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18347 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18348 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18349 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18350 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18351 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353url : string
18354 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18355 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18356 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18357 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18358 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18359 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18360 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362 ACL derivatives :
18363 url : exact string match
18364 url_beg : prefix match
18365 url_dir : subdir match
18366 url_dom : domain match
18367 url_end : suffix match
18368 url_len : length match
18369 url_reg : regex match
18370 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372url_ip : ip
18373 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18374 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18375 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18376 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18377 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18378 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18379 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381url_port : integer
18382 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18383 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18384 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18385 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018386
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018387urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18388url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18390 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018391 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18392 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18393 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18394 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18396 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018397 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18398 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400 ACL derivatives :
18401 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18402 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18403 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18404 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18405 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18406 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18407 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18408 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018409
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411 Example :
18412 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18413 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18414 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18415 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018416
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018417urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18419 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18420 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018421
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018422url32 : integer
18423 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18424 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18425 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18426 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18427 is an unsigned integer.
18428
18429url32+src : binary
18430 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18431 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18432 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18433
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018434
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184357.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018436---------------------------------------
18437
18438This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18439used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18440purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18441There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18442or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18443any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18444for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18445
18446internal.htx.data : integer
18447 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18448 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18449
18450internal.htx.free : integer
18451 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18452 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18453
18454internal.htx.free_data : integer
18455 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18456 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18457
18458internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18459 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18460 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18461 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18462
18463internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18464 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18465 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18466
18467internal.htx.size : integer
18468 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18469 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18470
18471internal.htx.used : integer
18472 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18473 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18474 direction.
18475
18476internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18477 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18478 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18479 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18480 of the special value :
18481 * head : The oldest inserted block
18482 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018483 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018484
18485internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18486 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18487 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18488 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18489 integer or one of the special value :
18490 * head : The oldest inserted block
18491 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018492 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018493
18494internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18495 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18496 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18497 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18498 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18499
18500 * head : The oldest inserted block
18501 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018502 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018503
18504internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18505 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18506 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18507 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18508 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18509
18510 * head : The oldest inserted block
18511 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018512 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018513
18514internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18515 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18516 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18517 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18518 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18519
18520 * head : The oldest inserted block
18521 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018522 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018523
18524internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18525 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18526 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18527 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18528 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18529
18530 * head : The oldest inserted block
18531 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018532 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018533
18534internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18535 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18536 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18537 it returns false.
18538
18539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185407.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018541---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018543Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18544every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018545order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018547ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18548---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018549FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018550HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018551HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18552HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018553HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18554HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18555HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18556HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18557LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018558METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018559METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018560METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18561METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18562METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18563METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018564METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018565METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018566RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018567REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018568TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018569WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18570---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018571
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185738. Logging
18574----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018575
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018576One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18577provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18578very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18579provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18580state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018581to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018582headers.
18583
18584In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18585about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18586send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18587
18588 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18589 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18590 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18591 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18592 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018593 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018594 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018595
18596The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18597allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18598as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18599while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18600real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18601delay.
18602
18603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186048.1. Log levels
18605---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018607TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018609HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18610in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18611track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18612syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18613about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018614
18615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186168.2. Log formats
18617----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018618
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018619HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018620and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18621slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18622options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018623
18624 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18625 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18626 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18627 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18628 extents.
18629
18630 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18631 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18632 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18633 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18634 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18635
18636 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18637 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18638 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18639 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18640 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18641
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018642 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18643 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18644 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18645 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18646
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018647 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18648
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018649Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18650specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18651field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18652servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18653always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18654identifier.
18655
18656Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18657 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18658 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18659 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18660 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18661
18662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186638.2.1. Default log format
18664-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018665
18666This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18667as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18668format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18669
18670 Example :
18671 listen www
18672 mode http
18673 log global
18674 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18675
18676 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18677 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18678 (www/HTTP)
18679
18680 Field Format Extract from the example above
18681 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18682 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18683 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18684 4 'to' to
18685 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18686 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18687
18688Detailed fields description :
18689 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18690 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18691 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18692 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18693 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18694 and processed the connection.
18695 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18696
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018697In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18698"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18699connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018701It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18702will eventually disappear.
18703
18704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187058.2.2. TCP log format
18706---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707
18708The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18709is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18710information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18711counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18712emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18713environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18714the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18715sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018716specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18717not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18718fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18719marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018720
18721 Example :
18722 frontend fnt
18723 mode tcp
18724 option tcplog
18725 log global
18726 default_backend bck
18727
18728 backend bck
18729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18730
18731 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18732 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18733 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18734
18735 Field Format Extract from the example above
18736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18737 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18738 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18739 4 frontend_name fnt
18740 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18741 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18742 7 bytes_read* 212
18743 8 termination_state --
18744 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18745 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18746
18747Detailed fields description :
18748 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018749 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18750 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18751 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018752 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018753 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018754 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018755
18756 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018757 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18758 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18759 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018760
18761 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18762 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18763 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018764 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18765 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18766 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18767 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018768
18769 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18770 and processed the connection.
18771
18772 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18773 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18774 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18775 applications.
18776
18777 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18778 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18779 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18780 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18781 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18782
18783 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18784 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18785 See "Timers" below for more details.
18786
18787 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18788 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18789 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18790 "Timers" below for more details.
18791
18792 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018793 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018794 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18795 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18796 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18797 details.
18798
18799 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18800 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18801 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18802 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18803 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18804
18805 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18806 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18807 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18808 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18809 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18810 for more details.
18811
18812 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018813 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018814 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18815 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18816 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018817 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018818
18819 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18820 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18821 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18822 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18823 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18824 caused by a denial of service attack.
18825
18826 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18827 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18828 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18829 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18830 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18831 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18832 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18833 denial of service attack.
18834
18835 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18836 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18837 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18838 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18839 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18840 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18841 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18842 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18843 be processed than on other servers.
18844
18845 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18846 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18847 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18848 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18849 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18850 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18851 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18852 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18853 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18854 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18855 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18856 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18857 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18858
18859 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18860 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18861 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18862 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18863 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18864 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018865 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018866 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18867
18868 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18869 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18870 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18871 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18872 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18873 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018874 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018875 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18876 occurs.
18877
18878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188798.2.3. HTTP log format
18880----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018881
18882The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18883is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18884the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18885are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18886emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18887generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18888"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18889which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018890frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18891is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018892
18893Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18894slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18895with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18896
18897 Example :
18898 frontend http-in
18899 mode http
18900 option httplog
18901 log global
18902 default_backend bck
18903
18904 backend static
18905 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18906
18907 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18908 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18909 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018910 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018911
18912 Field Format Extract from the example above
18913 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18914 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018915 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018916 4 frontend_name http-in
18917 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018918 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018919 7 status_code 200
18920 8 bytes_read* 2750
18921 9 captured_request_cookie -
18922 10 captured_response_cookie -
18923 11 termination_state ----
18924 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18925 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18926 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18927 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18928 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018930Detailed fields description :
18931 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018932 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18933 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18934 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018935 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018936 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018937 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018938
18939 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018940 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18941 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18942 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018944 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18945 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018946
18947 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18948 and processed the connection.
18949
18950 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18951 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18952 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18953
18954 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18955 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18956 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18957 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18958 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18959 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018961 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18962 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18963 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018964 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018965 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18966 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018967 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18968 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018969
18970 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18971 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018972 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018973
18974 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18975 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018976 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18977 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018978
18979 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18980 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18981 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18982 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18983 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018984 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18985 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018987 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18988 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18989 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18990 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18991 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18992 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18993 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018994 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018995
18996 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18997 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18998 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18999
19000 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19001 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019002 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019003 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19004 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19005 overflowing.
19006
19007 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19008 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19009 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19010 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19011 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19012 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19013 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19014 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19015
19016 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19017 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19018 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19019 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19020 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19021 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19022 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19023 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19024
19025 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19026 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19027 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19028 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19029 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19030 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19031 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19032
19033 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019034 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019035 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19036 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19037 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019038 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039 system.
19040
19041 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19042 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19043 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19044 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19045 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19046 caused by a denial of service attack.
19047
19048 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19049 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19050 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19051 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19052 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19053 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19054 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19055 denial of service attack.
19056
19057 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19058 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19059 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19060 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19061 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19062 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19063 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19064 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19065 processed than on other servers.
19066
19067 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19068 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19069 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19070 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19071 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19072 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19073 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19074 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19075 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19076 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19077 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19078 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19079 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19080
19081 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19082 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19083 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19084 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19085 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19086 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019087 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019088 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19089
19090 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19091 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19092 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19093 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19094 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19095 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019096 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019097 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19098 occurs.
19099
19100 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19101 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19102 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19103 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19104 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19105 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19106 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19107 cookies" below for more details.
19108
19109 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19110 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19111 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19112 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19113 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19114 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19115 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19116 and cookies" below for more details.
19117
19118 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19119 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19120 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19121 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19122 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19123 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19124 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19125 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19126
19127
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200191288.2.4. Custom log format
19129------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019130
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019131The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019132mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019134HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019135Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19136separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19137prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19138
19139Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19140variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019141("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019142
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019143If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019144as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019145less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19146the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19147
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019148Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19149"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19150delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19151preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019152
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019153Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19154'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19155https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19156such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019158Flags are :
19159 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019160 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019161 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19162 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019163
19164 Example:
19165
19166 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19167 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19168
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019169 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19170
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019171At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19172
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019173 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19174 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019175
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019176the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019178 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19179 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19180 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019181
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019182and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19183
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019184 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19185 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019187Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19188
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019189 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019190 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019191 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19192 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19193 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019194 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19195 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19196 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019197 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019198 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19199 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019200 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019201 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19202 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019203 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019204 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019205 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019206 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019207 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019208 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019209 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019210 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19211 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19212 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19213 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19214 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019215 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019216 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019217 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019218 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019219 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019220 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19221 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019222 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19223 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19224 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019225 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019226 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19227 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019228 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019229 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19230 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19231 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019232 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019233 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019234 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19235 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19236 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19237 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019238 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019239 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019240 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019241 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019242 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019243 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019244 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19245 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19246 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019247 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019248 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19249 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019250 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019251 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19252 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019253 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019254 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019255 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019256 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019257
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019258 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019259
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019260
192618.2.5. Error log format
19262-----------------------
19263
19264When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19265protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19266By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19267"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019268will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019269logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19270
19271The format looks like this :
19272
19273 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19274 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19275 Connection error during SSL handshake
19276
19277 Field Format Extract from the example above
19278 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19279 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19280 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19281 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19282 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19283
19284These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19285failures.
19286
19287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192888.3. Advanced logging options
19289-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019290
19291Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19292just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19293options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19294for more information about their usage.
19295
19296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19298------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019299
19300It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19301haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19302commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19303monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19304ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19305
19306 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19307 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19308 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19309 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19310
19311 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19312 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19313 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019314 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315 such as other load-balancers.
19316
19317 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19318 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19319 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19320
19321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193228.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19323----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019324
19325The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19326what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19327or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019328"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019329just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19330log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19331after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19332is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19333with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19334with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19335
19336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193378.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19338------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019339
19340Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19341for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19342"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19343retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19344raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19345a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19346file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19347you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19348"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19349
19350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193518.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19352--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019353
19354Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19355multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19356them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19357"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19358logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19359error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19360and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19361too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19362useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19363alternative.
19364
19365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193668.4. Timing events
19367------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019368
19369Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19370reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19371the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19372frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019373mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19374addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19375
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019376Timings events in HTTP mode:
19377
19378 first request 2nd request
19379 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19380 t tr t tr ...
19381 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19382 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19383 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19384 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019385 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019386 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19387
19388Timings events in TCP mode:
19389
19390 TCP session
19391 |<----------------->|
19392 t t
19393 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19394 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19395 |<------ Tt ------->|
19396
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019397 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019398 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019399 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19400 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19401 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019402 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019403 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19404 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19405 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19406 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019407
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019408 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19409 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19410 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019411 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19412 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19413 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19414 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19415 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19416 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019417
19418 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19419 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19420 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19421 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19422 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19423 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19424 request typed by hand during a test.
19425
19426 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19427 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019428 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019429 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19430 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19431 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19432 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019433
19434 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19435 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19436 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19437 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19438 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19439
19440 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19441 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19442 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19443 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19444 connection never established.
19445
19446 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19447 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19448 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19449 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19450 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19451 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19452 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19453 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19454 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19455 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19456 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19457
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019458 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19459 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19460 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19461 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19462 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19463 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19464
19465 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19466
19467 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19468 "Ta" can never be negative.
19469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019470 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19471 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019472 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19473 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019474 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019475
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019476 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019477
19478 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019479 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19480 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019481
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019482 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19483 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19484 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19485 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19486 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19487 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19488 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19489 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019491These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19492protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19493that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019494due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19495"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19496that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019497
19498Most common cases :
19499
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019500 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19501 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19502 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19503 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19504 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19505 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19506 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19507 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19508 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19509 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19510 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019511 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019512
19513 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19514 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19515 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19516 of ms on remote networks.
19517
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019518 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19519 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19520 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019521
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019522 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19523 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19524 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19525 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19526 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19527 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19528 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19529 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19530 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019531
19532Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19533
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019534 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019535 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019536 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019537
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019538 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019539 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19540 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19541
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019542 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019543 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19544 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19545 flags.
19546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019547 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19548 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019549 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19550 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19551 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19552 the client connection was maintained open.
19553
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019554 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019555 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019556 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019557 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19558
19559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195608.5. Session state at disconnection
19561-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019562
19563TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19564"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195652-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19566each of which has a special meaning :
19567
19568 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19569 session to terminate :
19570
19571 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19572
19573 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19574 server explicitly refused it.
19575
19576 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19577 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19578 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19579 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019580 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019581
19582 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19583 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019584
19585 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19586 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19587 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19588 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19589 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19590
19591 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19592 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19593 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19594 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19595 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19596
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019597 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19598 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19599
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019600 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19601 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19602 backup connections when going up.
19603
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019604 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019606 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19607 send or receive data.
19608
19609 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19610 send or receive data.
19611
19612 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19613 with nothing left in the buffers.
19614
19615 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19616
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019617 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019618 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19619
19620 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19621 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19622 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19623 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19624 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19625
19626 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19627 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19628
19629 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19630 server (HTTP only).
19631
19632 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19633
19634 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19635 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19636 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19637
19638 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19639 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19640 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19641
19642 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19643
19644 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19645 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19646
19647 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19648 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19649 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19650
19651 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19652 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019653 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19654 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019655
19656 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19657 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19658 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19659 another server.
19660
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019661 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019662 server.
19663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019664 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19665 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19666 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19667 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19668
19669 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19670 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19671 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19672 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19673
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019674 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19675 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19676 "use-server" rule).
19677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019678 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19679
19680 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19681 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19682
19683 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19684
19685 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19686 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19687 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19688
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019689 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19690 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019691 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019692 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19693 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19694
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019695 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19696
19697 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19698 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19699
19700 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19701
19702 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19703
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019704The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19705was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019706helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19707starvation, attacks, etc...
19708
19709The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19710alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19711easier finding and understanding.
19712
19713 Flags Reason
19714
19715 -- Normal termination.
19716
19717 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19718 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19719 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19720 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19721
19722 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19723 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19724 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19725 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19726 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19727 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019728
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019729 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19730 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019731 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019732
19733 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19734 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19735 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19736
19737 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19738 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19739 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19740 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19741 the server takes too long to respond.
19742
19743 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19744 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19745 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19746 long a time to respond.
19747
19748 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19749 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19750 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19751 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019752 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19753 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754
19755 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19756 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19757 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19758 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19759 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019760 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019761 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19762 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19763 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19764 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19765 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19766 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19767 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19768 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019769 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019770 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19771 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19772 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019773
19774 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19775 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019776 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19777 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19778 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19779 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019780
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019781 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19782 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019784 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019785 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19786 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019787 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019788 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19789 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19790
19791 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19792 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19793 503 or 504 here.
19794
19795 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19796 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19797 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19798 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19799 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19800
19801 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19802 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019803 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019804 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19805 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19806
19807 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19808 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19809 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19810 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19811 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19812 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19813 between haproxy and the server.
19814
19815 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19816 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19817 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19818 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19819 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19820 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19821 solution is to fix the application.
19822
19823 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19824 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19825 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19826 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19827 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19828 external attacks.
19829
19830 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19831 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019832 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019833 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19834 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19835
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019836 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19837 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19838 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019839 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019840 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019841
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019842 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19843 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19844 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19845 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019846 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19847 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19848 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19849 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19850 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019851
19852 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19853 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19854 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19855 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19856
19857 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19858 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19859 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19860 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19861
19862 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19863 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19864 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19865 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19866
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019867The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19868persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19869important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19870re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19871
19872 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19873
19874 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19875 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19876 set on a GET request.
19877
19878 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19879 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019880 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019881 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19882
19883 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19884 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19885 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19886
19887 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19888 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19889 already got a cookie.
19890
19891 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19892 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19893 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19894 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19895 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19896
19897 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19898 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19899 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19900
19901 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19902 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19903 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19904
19905 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19906 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19907
19908 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19909 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19910 then advertised in the response.
19911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199138.6. Non-printable characters
19914-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915
19916In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19917consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19918converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19919prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19920being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19921escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19922is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19923'}' when logging headers.
19924
19925Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19926issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19927containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19928
19929Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19930the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19931performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19932
19933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199348.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19935---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019936
19937Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19938achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019939section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019940cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19941the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19942the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019943locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019944not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19945user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19946a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19947wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19948
19949 Examples :
19950 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19951 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19952
19953 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19954 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19955
19956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199578.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19958---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019959
19960Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19961proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19962the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19963server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19964
19965Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19966response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019967section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019968
19969It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019970time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19971appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19973and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19974follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19975request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19976in the logs.
19977
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019978As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19979frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19980an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019982 Example :
19983 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19984 listen proxy-out
19985 mode http
19986 option httplog
19987 option logasap
19988 log global
19989 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19990
19991 # log the name of the virtual server
19992 capture request header Host len 20
19993
19994 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19995 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19996
19997 # log the beginning of the referrer
19998 capture request header Referer len 20
19999
20000 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20001 capture response header Server len 20
20002
20003 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20004 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020006 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020007 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20008
20009 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20010 capture response header Via len 20
20011
20012 # log the URL location during a redirection
20013 capture response header Location len 20
20014
20015 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20016 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20017 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20018 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20019 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20020
20021 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20022 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20023 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20024 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020025 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020026
20027 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20028 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20029 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20030 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20031 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020032 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033
20034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200358.9. Examples of logs
20036---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020037
20038These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20039them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20040reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20041
20042 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20043 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20044 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20045
20046 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20047 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20048
20049 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20050 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20051 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20052
20053 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20054 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20055
20056 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20057 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20058 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20059
20060 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020061 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020062 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20063 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20064
20065 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20066 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20067 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20068
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020069 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20070 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20071 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20072 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20073 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20074 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075
20076 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020077 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078
20079 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20080 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20081 Nothing was sent to any server.
20082
20083 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20084 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20085
20086 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20087 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020088 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020089 send a 408 return code to the client.
20090
20091 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20092 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20093
20094 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20095 5 seconds ("c----").
20096
20097 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20098 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020099 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100
20101 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020102 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20104 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20105 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20106 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20107 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020108
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020109
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200201109. Supported filters
20111--------------------
20112
20113Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20114accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20115unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20116
20117See also : "filter"
20118
201199.1. Trace
20120----------
20121
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020122filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020123
20124 Arguments:
20125 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20126 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20127
20128 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20129 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20130 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20131 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020133 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020134 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20135 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20136 amount of the parsed data.
20137
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020138 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020139
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020140This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20141callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20142information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20143filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20144
20145Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20146tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20147a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20148
20149
201509.2. HTTP compression
20151---------------------
20152
20153filter compression
20154
20155The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20156keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020157when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20158fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20159done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20160explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20161filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20162listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20163order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020164
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020165See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20166 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020167
20168
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201699.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20170--------------------------------------------
20171
20172filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20173
20174 Arguments :
20175
20176 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20177 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20178 parsed.
20179
20180 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20181 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20182 part must be placed in its own scope.
20183
20184The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20185external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020186streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020187exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20188also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20189
20190SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20191the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20192
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020193For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020194"doc/SPOE.txt".
20195
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201969.4. Cache
20197----------
20198
20199filter cache <name>
20200
20201 Arguments :
20202
20203 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20204
20205The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20206"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020207cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020208other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20209case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20210is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20211filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020212listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20213order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020214
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020215See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20216 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20217
20218
202199.5. Fcgi-app
20220-------------
20221
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020222filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020223
20224 Arguments :
20225
20226 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20227
20228The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20229request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20230reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20231used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20232implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20233used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20234fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20235used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20236order.
20237
20238See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20239 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20240
20241
2024210. FastCGI applications
20243-------------------------
20244
20245HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20246feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20247the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20248FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20249servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20250FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20251backend.
20252
20253HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20254application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20255connection.
20256
2025710.1. Setup
20258-----------
20259
2026010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20261--------------------------
20262
20263fcgi-app <name>
20264 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20265 document root must be defined.
20266
20267acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20268 Declare or complete an access list.
20269
20270 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20271 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20272 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20273 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20274 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20275
20276docroot <path>
20277 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20278 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20279 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20280
20281index <script-name>
20282 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20283 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20284 is an optional setting.
20285
20286 Example :
20287 index index.php
20288
20289log-stderr global
20290log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20291 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20292 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20293
20294 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20295 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20296
20297pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20298 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20299 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20300 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20301
20302 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20303 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20304 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20305 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20306
20307 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20308 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20309
20310path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020311 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020312 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20313 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20314 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20315 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20316 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20317 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20318 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020319
20320 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020321 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020322 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20323 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20324 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20325 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020326
20327 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020328 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20329 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020330
20331option get-values
20332no option get-values
20333 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20334
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020335 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020336 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20337
20338 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20339 application will accept.
20340
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020341 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20342 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020343
20344 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020345 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020346 option is disabled.
20347
20348 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20349 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20350 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20351 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20352 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20353 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20354
20355option keep-conn
20356no option keep-conn
20357 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20358 sending a response.
20359
20360 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20361 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20362
20363option max-reqs <reqs>
20364 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20365 accept.
20366
20367 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20368 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20369 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20370 to 1.
20371
20372option mpxs-conns
20373no option mpxs-conns
20374 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20375
20376 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20377 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20378
20379set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20380 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20381 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20382 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20383 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20384
20385 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20386 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20387 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20388
20389 Example :
20390 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20391 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20392
20393 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20394
20395
2039610.1.2. Proxy section
20397---------------------
20398
20399use-fcgi-app <name>
20400 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20401
20402 Arguments :
20403 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20404
20405 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20406 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20407 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20408 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20409 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20410
20411 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20412 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20413 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20414 application are evaluated.
20415
20416
2041710.1.3. Example
20418---------------
20419
20420 frontend front-http
20421 mode http
20422 bind *:80
20423 bind *:
20424
20425 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20426 default_backend back-static
20427
20428 backend back-static
20429 mode http
20430 server www A.B.C.D:80
20431
20432 backend back-dynamic
20433 mode http
20434 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20435 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20436
20437 fcgi-app php-fpm
20438 log-stderr global
20439 option keep-conn
20440
20441 docroot /var/www/my-app
20442 index index.php
20443 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20444
20445
2044610.2. Default parameters
20447------------------------
20448
20449A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20450the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020451script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020452applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20453
20454 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20455 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20456 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20457 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20458 | | |
20459 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20460 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20461 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20462 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20463 | | application. |
20464 | | |
20465 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20466 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20467 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20468 | | |
20469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20470 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20471 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20472 | | the application's configuration. |
20473 | | |
20474 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20475 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20476 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20477 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20478 | | |
20479 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20480 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20481 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20482 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20483 | | be defined. |
20484 | | |
20485 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20486 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20487 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20488 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20489 | | is not set too. |
20490 | | |
20491 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20492 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20493 | | set. |
20494 | | |
20495 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20496 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20497 | | the request. |
20498 | | |
20499 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20500 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20501 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20502 | | |
20503 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20504 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20505 | | script to process the request. |
20506 | | |
20507 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20508 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20509 | | |
20510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20511 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20512 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20513 | | |
20514 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20515 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20516 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20517 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20518 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20519 | | |
20520 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20521 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20522 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20523 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20524 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20525 | | side. |
20526 | | |
20527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20528 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20529 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20530 | | connected to. |
20531 | | |
20532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20533 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20534 | | |
20535 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20536 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20537 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20538 | | |
20539 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20540
20541
2054210.3. Limitations
20543------------------
20544
20545The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20546way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20547during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20548establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20549application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20550or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20551message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20552these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20553and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20554
20555Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20556request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20557requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20558
20559About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20560into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20561fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20562"http-request" ones.
20563
20564Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20565FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20566processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20567must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20568here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020570/*
20571 * Local variables:
20572 * fill-column: 79
20573 * End:
20574 */